blob: 7eb89787f99b80276e7a4da1c6abb7800bd9b481 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000042 ExprResult E = S.Owned(new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc));
43 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
44 if (E.isInvalid())
45 return ExprError();
46 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000047}
48
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000049static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
50 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000051 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
52 bool CStyle);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000053
54static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
55 QualType &ToType,
56 bool InOverloadResolution,
57 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
58 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000059static OverloadingResult
60IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
61 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
62 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
63 bool AllowExplicit);
64
65
66static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
67CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
68 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
70
71static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
72CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
73 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
75
76static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
77CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
78 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
80
81
82
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000083/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
84/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000086GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
87 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
88 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
89 ICC_Identity,
90 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
91 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
92 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000093 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000094 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
95 ICC_Promotion,
96 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000097 ICC_Promotion,
98 ICC_Conversion,
99 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Conversion,
101 ICC_Conversion,
102 ICC_Conversion,
103 ICC_Conversion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000109 ICC_Conversion
110 };
111 return Category[(int)Kind];
112}
113
114/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
115/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
116ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
117 static const ImplicitConversionRank
118 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
119 ICR_Exact_Match,
120 ICR_Exact_Match,
121 ICR_Exact_Match,
122 ICR_Exact_Match,
123 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000124 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000125 ICR_Promotion,
126 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000127 ICR_Promotion,
128 ICR_Conversion,
129 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000130 ICR_Conversion,
131 ICR_Conversion,
132 ICR_Conversion,
133 ICR_Conversion,
134 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000135 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000139 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000142 };
143 return Rank[(int)Kind];
144}
145
146/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
147/// implicit conversion.
148const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000149 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 "No conversion",
151 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
152 "Array-to-pointer",
153 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000154 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 "Qualification",
156 "Integral promotion",
157 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000158 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000159 "Integral conversion",
160 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000161 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000162 "Floating-integral conversion",
163 "Pointer conversion",
164 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000165 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000166 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000167 "Derived-to-base conversion",
168 "Vector conversion",
169 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000170 "Complex-real conversion",
171 "Block Pointer conversion",
172 "Transparent Union Conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 };
174 return Name[Kind];
175}
176
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000177/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
178/// sequence to the identity conversion.
179void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
180 First = ICK_Identity;
181 Second = ICK_Identity;
182 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000183 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000184 ReferenceBinding = false;
185 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000186 IsLvalueReference = true;
187 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
188 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000189 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000190 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000191}
192
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000193/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
194/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
195/// implicit conversions.
196ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
197 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
198 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
199 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
200 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
201 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
202 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
203 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
204 return Rank;
205}
206
207/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
208/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000209/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000211bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000212 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
213 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
214 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
215 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000216 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000217 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
218 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
219 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000220 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
222 return true;
223
224 return false;
225}
226
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000227/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
228/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
229/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
230/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000231bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000232StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000234 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000235 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000236
237 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
238 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
239 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
240 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
241 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
242
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000243 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000244 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000245 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
246
247 return false;
248}
249
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000250/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
251/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
252void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000253 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000254 bool PrintedSomething = false;
255 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000256 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000257 PrintedSomething = true;
258 }
259
260 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
261 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000262 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000265
266 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000267 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000268 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000269 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000270 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000271 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000272 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000273 PrintedSomething = true;
274 }
275
276 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
277 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000278 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000279 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000280 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000281 PrintedSomething = true;
282 }
283
284 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000285 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000286 }
287}
288
289/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
290/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
291void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000292 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000293 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
294 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000295 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000296 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000297 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000298 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000299 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000300 After.DebugPrint();
301 }
302}
303
304/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
305/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
306void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000307 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000308 switch (ConversionKind) {
309 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000310 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000311 Standard.DebugPrint();
312 break;
313 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000314 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000315 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
316 break;
317 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000318 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000319 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000320 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000321 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000322 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000323 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000324 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000325 break;
326 }
327
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000328 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000329}
330
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000331void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
332 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
333}
334
335void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
336 conversions().~ConversionSet();
337}
338
339void
340AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
341 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
342 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
343 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
344}
345
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000346namespace {
347 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
348 // template parameter and template argument information.
349 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
350 TemplateParameter Param;
351 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
352 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
353 };
354}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000355
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000356/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
357/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
358OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000359static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
360 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000361 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000362 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
363 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
364 Result.Data = 0;
365 switch (TDK) {
366 case Sema::TDK_Success:
367 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000368 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
369 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000370 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000371
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000372 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000373 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000374 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
375 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000376
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000377 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000378 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000379 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
380 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000381 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
382 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
383 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
384 Result.Data = Saved;
385 break;
386 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000387
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000388 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000389 Result.Data = Info.take();
390 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000391
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000392 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000393 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000394 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000395 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000396
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000397 return Result;
398}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000399
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000400void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
401 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
402 case Sema::TDK_Success:
403 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
404 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000405 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
406 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000407 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000408 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000409
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000410 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000411 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000412 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000413 Data = 0;
414 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000415
416 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
417 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
418 Data = 0;
419 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000420
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000421 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000422 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000423 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
424 break;
425 }
426}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000427
428TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000429OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
430 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
431 case Sema::TDK_Success:
432 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000433 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
434 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000435 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000436 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000437
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000438 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000439 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000440 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000441
442 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000443 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000444 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000445
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000446 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000447 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000448 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
449 break;
450 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000451
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000452 return TemplateParameter();
453}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000454
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000455TemplateArgumentList *
456OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
457 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
458 case Sema::TDK_Success:
459 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
460 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
461 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
462 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
463 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
464 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000465 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000466 return 0;
467
468 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
469 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000470
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000471 // Unhandled
472 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
473 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
474 break;
475 }
476
477 return 0;
478}
479
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000480const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
481 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
482 case Sema::TDK_Success:
483 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
484 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000485 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
486 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000487 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000488 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000489 return 0;
490
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000491 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000492 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000493 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000494
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000495 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000497 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
498 break;
499 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000500
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000501 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000502}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000503
504const TemplateArgument *
505OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
506 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
507 case Sema::TDK_Success:
508 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
509 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000510 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
511 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000512 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000513 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000514 return 0;
515
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000516 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000517 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
519
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000520 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000521 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000522 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
523 break;
524 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000525
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000526 return 0;
527}
528
529void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000530 inherited::clear();
531 Functions.clear();
532}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000533
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000534// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000535// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
536// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
537// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
538// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000539// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
540// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
541// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000542//
543// Example: Given the following input:
544//
545// void f(int, float); // #1
546// void f(int, int); // #2
547// int f(int, int); // #3
548//
549// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000550// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000551//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000552// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
553// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
554// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
555// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000556//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000557// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
558// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
559// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
560// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000561// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
562// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000563//
564// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
565// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
566// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
567// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000568Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000569Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
570 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000571 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000572 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000573 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
574
575 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
577 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
578
579 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
580 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
581 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
582
583 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
584 }
585
586 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
587 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
588 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
589 // function templates hide function templates with different
590 // return types or template parameter lists.
591 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
592 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
593
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000594 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000595 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
596 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
597 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
598 continue;
599 }
600
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000601 Match = *I;
602 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000603 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000604 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000605 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
606 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
607 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
608 continue;
609 }
610
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000611 Match = *I;
612 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000613 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000614 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000615 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
616 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
617 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000618 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
619 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000620 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
621 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
622 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
623 // template instantiation.
624 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000625 // (C++ 13p1):
626 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
627 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000628 Match = *I;
629 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000630 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000631 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000632
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000633 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000634}
635
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000636bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
637 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000638 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
639 // overloads.
640 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
641 return false;
642
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000643 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
644 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
645
646 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
647 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
648 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
649 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
650 return true;
651
652 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
653 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
654 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
655
656 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
657 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
658 // in the signature, they are overloads.
659
660 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
661 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
662 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
663 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
664 return false;
665
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000666 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
667 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000668
669 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
670 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
671 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
672 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
673 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
674 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000675 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000676 return true;
677
678 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
679 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
680 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
681 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
682 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
683 // signature.
684 //
685 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
686 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000687 //
688 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
689 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
690 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000691 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
692 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
693 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
694 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
695 return true;
696
697 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000698 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000699 //
700 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
701 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
702 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
703 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
704 // can be overloaded.
705 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
706 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
707 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
708 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000709 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000710 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
711 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
712 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
713 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
714 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
715 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000716 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
717 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
718 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
719 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000720 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
721 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
722 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
723 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
724 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000725
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000726 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000727 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000728
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000729 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
730 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000731}
732
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000733/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
734/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
735/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
736/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000737///
738/// void f(float f);
739/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
740///
741/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
742/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
743/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
744/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
745//
746/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
747/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
748/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
749/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
750/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000751///
752/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
753/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000754/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
755/// permitted.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000756static ImplicitConversionSequence
757TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
758 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000759 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000760 bool InOverloadResolution,
761 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000762 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000763 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000764 ICS.Standard, CStyle)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000765 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000766 return ICS;
767 }
768
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000769 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000770 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000771 return ICS;
772 }
773
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000774 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
775 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
776 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
777 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
778 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
779 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
780 // called for those cases.
781 QualType FromType = From->getType();
782 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000783 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
784 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000785 ICS.setStandard();
786 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
787 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
788 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000789
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000790 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
791 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
792 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
793 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
794 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000795
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000796 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000797 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000798 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000799
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000800 return ICS;
801 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000802
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000803 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
804 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
805 // we can perform.
806 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000807 return ICS;
808 }
809
810 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000811 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
812 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000813 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000814 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000815
816 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000817 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000818 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
819 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
820 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
821 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
822 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
823 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
824 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000825 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000826 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000827 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000828 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
829 QualType ToCanon
830 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000831 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000832 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000833 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
834 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000835 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000836 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000837 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000838 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000839 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000840 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000841 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
842 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000843 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000844
845 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
846 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
847 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
848 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
849 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
850 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
851 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000852 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000853 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000854 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000855 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000856 ICS.setAmbiguous();
857 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
858 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
859 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
860 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
861 if (Cand->Viable)
862 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000863 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000864 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000865 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000866
867 return ICS;
868}
869
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000870bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence,
871 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
872 Expr *Initializer,
873 bool SuppressUserConversions,
874 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000875 bool InOverloadResolution,
876 bool CStyle) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000877 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
878 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(),
879 SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000880 AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000881 InOverloadResolution,
882 CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000883 if (ICS.isBad()) return true;
884
885 // Perform the actual conversion.
886 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType());
887 return false;
888}
889
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000890/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000891/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000892/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
893/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
894/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000895ExprResult
896Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000897 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
898 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
899 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
900}
901
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000902ExprResult
903Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000904 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
905 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000906 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
907 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
908 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000909 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
910 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000911 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
912}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000913
914/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000915/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000916static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000917 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
918 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
919 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000920
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000921 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
922 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
923 // - a pointer
924 // - a member pointer
925 // - a block pointer
926 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
927 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
928 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
929 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
930 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
931 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
932 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
933 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
934 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
935 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
936 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
937 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
938 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
939 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
940 } else {
941 return false;
942 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000943
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000944 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
945 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
946 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
947 return false;
948 }
949
950 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
951 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
952 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
953
954 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
955 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
956 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
957
958 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000959 return true;
960}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000961
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000962/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
963/// vector conversion.
964///
965/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
966/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000967static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
968 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000969 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
970 // conversion.
971 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
972 return false;
973
974 // Identical types require no conversions.
975 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
976 return false;
977
978 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
979 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
980 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
981 // identity conversion.
982 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
983 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000984
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000985 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000986 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000987 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
988 return true;
989 }
990 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000991
992 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
993 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
994 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
995 // same size
996 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
997 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +0000998 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
999 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001000 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1001 return true;
1002 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001003 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001004
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001005 return false;
1006}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001007
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001008/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1009/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1010/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1011/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1012/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1013/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1014/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1015/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001016static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1017 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001018 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1019 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001020 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001021
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001022 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001023 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001024 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001025 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001026 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001027 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001028
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001029 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001030 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001031 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001032 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001033 return false;
1034
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001035 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001036 }
1037
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001038 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1039 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1040 // (C++ 4p1).
1041
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001042 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001043 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1044 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001045 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001046 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001047 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1048 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1049 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001050
1051 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1052 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1053 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1054 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1055 QualType resultTy;
1056 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1057 if (!IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType,
1058 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1059 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1060 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1061 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001062 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001063
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001064 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1065 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1066 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1067 // expression.
1068 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1069 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1070 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1071 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1072 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1073 == UO_AddrOf &&
1074 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1075 const Type *ClassType
1076 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1077 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001078 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1079 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1080 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001081 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1082 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1083 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001084
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001085 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001086 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1087 FromType,
1088 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001089 } else {
1090 return false;
1091 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001093 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001094 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1095 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001096 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1097 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001098 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001099 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001100 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001101
1102 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1103 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001104 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1105 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001106 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001107 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1108 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001109 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001110
1111 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1112 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1113 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001114 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001115
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001116 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001117 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001118 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001119
1120 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1121 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1122 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1123 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001124 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1125 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001126 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001127 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001128 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001129 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001130 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001131 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001132
1133 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1134 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1135 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001136 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001137 } else {
1138 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001139 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001141 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142
1143 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1144 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1145 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1146 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001147 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1148 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001149 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001150 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001151 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1153 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001154 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001155 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001156 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001157 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001158 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001159 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001160 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001161 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001162 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001163 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001164 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001165 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1166 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001167 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1168 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1169 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1170 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1171 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1172 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1173 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1174 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1175 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001176 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001177 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001178 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001179 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001180 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001181 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001182 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001183 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1184 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001185 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1186 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001187 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1188 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1189 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001190 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001191 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1192 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1193 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001195 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001196 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001197 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001198 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001199 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001200 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001201 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1202 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001203 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1204 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001205 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001206 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001207 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001208 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001209 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001210 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001211 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001212 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001213 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001214 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1215 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001216 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1217 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001218 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001219 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001220 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001221 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001222 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1223 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001224 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1225 InOverloadResolution,
1226 SCS, CStyle)) {
1227 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1228 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001229 } else {
1230 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001231 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001232 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001233 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001234
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001235 QualType CanonFrom;
1236 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001237 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001238 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001239 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001240 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001241 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1242 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001243 } else {
1244 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001245 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1246
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001247 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001248 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1249 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1250 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001251 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1252 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001253 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001254 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001255 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1256 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001257 FromType = ToType;
1258 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1259 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001260 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001261 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001262
1263 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1264 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001265 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001266 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001267
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001268 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001269}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001270
1271static bool
1272IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1273 QualType &ToType,
1274 bool InOverloadResolution,
1275 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1276 bool CStyle) {
1277
1278 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1279 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1280 return false;
1281 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1282 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1283 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1284 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1285 itend = UD->field_end();
1286 it != itend; ++it) {
1287 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, CStyle)) {
1288 ToType = it->getType();
1289 return true;
1290 }
1291 }
1292 return false;
1293}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001294
1295/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1296/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1297/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1298/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001299bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001300 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001301 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001302 if (!To) {
1303 return false;
1304 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001305
1306 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1307 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1308 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1309 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1310 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001311 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1312 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001313 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1314 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1315 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1316 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001317 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001318 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001319 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001320 }
1321
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001322 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1323 }
1324
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001325 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1326 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1327 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1328 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1329 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1330 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001331 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001332 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001333 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001334 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1335 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001336 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001337 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1338 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1339 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1340 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1341 return false;
1342
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001343 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001344 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001345 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001346 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1347 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001348 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001349
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001350 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001351 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1352 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1353 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001354 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001355 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001356 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001357 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001358 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001359 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001360 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001361 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1362 // unsigned.
1363 bool FromIsSigned;
1364 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001365
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001366 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1367 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001368
1369 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1370 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001371 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1372 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001373 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1374 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001375 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001376 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001377 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1378 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001379 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001380 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1381 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1382 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1383 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001384 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001385 }
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1390 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1391 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1392 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1393 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1394 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1395 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001396 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1397 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001398 using llvm::APSInt;
1399 if (From)
1400 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001401 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001402 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001403 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1404 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1405 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001406
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001407 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1408 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1409 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1410 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1411 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001412
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001413 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1414 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1415 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1416 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1417 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001418
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001419 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001420 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001421 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001422
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001423 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1424 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001425 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001426 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001427 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001428
1429 return false;
1430}
1431
1432/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1433/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1434/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001435bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001436 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1437 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001438 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1439 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001440 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1441 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001444 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1445 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1446 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1447 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1448 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1449 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1450 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1451 return true;
1452 }
1453
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001454 return false;
1455}
1456
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001457/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1458///
1459/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1460/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001461/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001462bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001463 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001464 if (!FromComplex)
1465 return false;
1466
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001467 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001468 if (!ToComplex)
1469 return false;
1470
1471 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001472 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1473 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1474 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001475}
1476
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001477/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1478/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1479/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1480/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1481/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001482static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001483BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001484 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1485 ASTContext &Context) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001486 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1487 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1488 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001489
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001490 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1491 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1492 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001493
1494 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001495 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001496 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001497 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001498
1499 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001500 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001501 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001502 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001503 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001504
1505 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1506 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001507 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1508 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001509 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1510 }
1511
1512 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001513 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1514 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001515
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001516 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1517 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1518 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001519}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001520
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001521static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001522 bool InOverloadResolution,
1523 ASTContext &Context) {
1524 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1525 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1526 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001527 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001528 return !InOverloadResolution;
1529
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001530 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1531 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1532 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001533}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001534
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001535/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1536/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1537/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1538/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1539/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1540/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001541///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001542/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1543/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1544/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1545/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1546/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1547/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001548/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1549/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1550/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001551bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001552 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001553 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001554 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001555 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001556 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1557 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001558 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001559
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001560 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1561 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001562 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001563 ConvertedType = ToType;
1564 return true;
1565 }
1566
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001567 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1568 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001569 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001570 ConvertedType = ToType;
1571 return true;
1572 }
1573 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1574 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001575 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001576 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001577 ConvertedType = ToType;
1578 return true;
1579 }
1580
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001581 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1582 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001583 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001584 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001585 ConvertedType = ToType;
1586 return true;
1587 }
1588
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001589 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001590 if (!ToTypePtr)
1591 return false;
1592
1593 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001594 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001595 ConvertedType = ToType;
1596 return true;
1597 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001598
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001599 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001600 // , including objective-c pointers.
1601 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1602 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001603 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1604 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1605 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001606 ToType, Context);
1607 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001608 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001609 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001610 if (!FromTypePtr)
1611 return false;
1612
1613 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001614
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001615 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001616 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1617 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1618 return false;
1619
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001620 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1621 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1622 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001623 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1624 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001625 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001626 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001627 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001628 return true;
1629 }
1630
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001631 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1632 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001633 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001634 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001635 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001636 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001637 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001638 return true;
1639 }
1640
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001641 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001642 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001643 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1644 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1645 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1646 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1647 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1648 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1649 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1650 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1651 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001652 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1653 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001654 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1655 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001656 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001657 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001658 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001659 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001660 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001661 ToType, Context);
1662 return true;
1663 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001664
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001665 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1666 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1667 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1668 ToPointeeType,
1669 ToType, Context);
1670 return true;
1671 }
1672
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001673 return false;
1674}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001675
1676/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1677static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1678 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1679
1680 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1681 if (TQs == Qs)
1682 return T;
1683
1684 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1685 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1686
1687 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1688}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001689
1690/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1691/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1692/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001693bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001694 QualType& ConvertedType,
1695 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1696 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1697 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001698
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001699 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
1700 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
1701
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001702 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001703 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1704 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001705 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001706 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001707
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001708 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001709 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1710 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1711 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1712 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1713 return false;
1714
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001715 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001716 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001717 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001718 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001719 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001720 return true;
1721 }
1722 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001723 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001724 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001725 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001726 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001727 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001728 return true;
1729 }
1730 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1731 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1732 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001733 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1734 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1735 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1736 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1737 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1738 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001739 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001740 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1741 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001742 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001743 return true;
1744 }
1745
1746 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1747 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1748 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1749 // complain about it.
1750 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001751 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001752 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1753 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001754 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001755 return true;
1756 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001757 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001758 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001759 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001760 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001761 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001762 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001763 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001764 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001765 // to a block pointer type.
1766 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001767 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001768 return true;
1769 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001770 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001771 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001772 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001773 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001774 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001775 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001776 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001777 return true;
1778 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001779 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001780 return false;
1781
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001782 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001783 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001784 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001785 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1786 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001787 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1788 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001789 return false;
1790
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001791 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1792 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1793 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1794 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1795 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1796 // We always complain about this conversion.
1797 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001798 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001799 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001800 return true;
1801 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001802 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1803 // as in I* to id.
1804 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1805 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1806 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1807 IncompatibleObjC)) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001808 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001809 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001810 return true;
1811 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001812
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001813 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001814 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1815 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1816 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001817 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001818 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001819 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001820 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001821 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1822 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1823 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1824 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1825 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1826 return false;
1827
1828 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1829 // function types are obviously different.
1830 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1831 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1832 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1833 return false;
1834
1835 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1836 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1837 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1838 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1839 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1840 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1841 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1842 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1843 HasObjCConversion = true;
1844 } else {
1845 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1846 return false;
1847 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001848
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001849 // Check argument types.
1850 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1851 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1852 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1853 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1854 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1855 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1856 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1857 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1858 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1859 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1860 HasObjCConversion = true;
1861 } else {
1862 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1863 return false;
1864 }
1865 }
1866
1867 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1868 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1869 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001870 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001871 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1872 return true;
1873 }
1874 }
1875
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001876 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001877}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001878
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001879bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1880 QualType& ConvertedType) {
1881 QualType ToPointeeType;
1882 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1883 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1884 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1885 else
1886 return false;
1887
1888 QualType FromPointeeType;
1889 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1890 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1891 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1892 else
1893 return false;
1894 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
1895 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1896 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
1897
1898 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
1899 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1900 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
1901 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1902
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001903 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
1904 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001905
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001906 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001907 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001908
1909 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1910 // function types are obviously different.
1911 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1912 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
1913 return false;
1914
1915 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1916 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1917 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
1918 return false;
1919
1920 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00001921 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1922 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001923 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1924 } else {
1925 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
1926 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
1927 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
1928 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
1929 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
1930
1931 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
1932 // OK exact match.
1933 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
1934 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1935 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1936 return false;
1937 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1938 }
1939 else
1940 return false;
1941 }
1942
1943 // Check argument types.
1944 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1945 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1946 IncompatibleObjC = false;
1947 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1948 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1949 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
1950 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1951 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
1952 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1953 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1954 return false;
1955 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1956 } else
1957 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1958 return false;
1959 }
1960 ConvertedType = ToType;
1961 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001962}
1963
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001964/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1965/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1966/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1967/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001968bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001969 const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001970 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1971 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1972 NewType->arg_type_begin());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001973
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001974 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1975 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1976 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1977 QualType ToType = (*O);
1978 QualType FromType = (*N);
1979 if (ToType != FromType) {
1980 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1981 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001982 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1983 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1984 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1985 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001986 continue;
1987 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001988 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1989 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001990 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001991 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1992 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1993 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001994 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001995 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001996 }
1997 }
1998 return true;
1999}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002000
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002001/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2002/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002003/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002004/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2005/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2006/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002007bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002008 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002009 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002010 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002011 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002012 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002013
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002014 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2015
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002016 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2017 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2018 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2019 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002020 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2021 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002022
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002023 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2024 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002025 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2026 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002027
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002028 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2029 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002030 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2031 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002032 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2033 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002034 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002035 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002036 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002037
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002038 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002039 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002040 }
2041 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002042 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002043 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002044 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002045 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002046 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2047 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2048 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002049 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002050 return false;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002051 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002052 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002053
2054 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2055 // reasons.
2056 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2057 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2058
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002059 return false;
2060}
2061
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002062/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2063/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2064/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2065/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2066/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2067bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002068 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002069 bool InOverloadResolution,
2070 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002071 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002072 if (!ToTypePtr)
2073 return false;
2074
2075 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002076 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2077 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2078 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002079 ConvertedType = ToType;
2080 return true;
2081 }
2082
2083 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002084 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002085 if (!FromTypePtr)
2086 return false;
2087
2088 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2089 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2090 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2091 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002092
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002093 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2094 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2095 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002096 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2097 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2098 return true;
2099 }
2100
2101 return false;
2102}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002103
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002104/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2105/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002106/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002107/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2108/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2109/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002110bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002111 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002112 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002113 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002114 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002115 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002116 if (!FromPtrType) {
2117 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002118 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002119 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002120 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002121 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002122 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002123 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002124
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002125 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002126 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2127 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002128
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002129 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2130 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002131
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002132 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2133 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2134 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002135
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002136 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002137 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002138 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2139 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2140 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2141 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002142
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002143 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2144 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002145 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2146 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2147 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2148 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002149 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002150
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002151 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002152 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2153 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2154 << From->getSourceRange();
2155 return true;
2156 }
2157
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002158 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002159 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2160 Paths.front(),
2161 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002162
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002163 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002164 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002165 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002166 return false;
2167}
2168
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002169/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2170/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2171/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002172bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002173Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002174 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002175 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2176 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2177
2178 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2179 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002180 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002181 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002182
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002183 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2184 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2185 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2186 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002187 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002188 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002189 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2190 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2191 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002192 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002193 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2194 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002195 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002196
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002197 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2198 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2199
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002200 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2201 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002202 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002203 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002204
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002205 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2206 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002207 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002208 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002209 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002211 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2212 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002213 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002214 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002215 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002216
2217 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2218 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2219 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2220 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2221 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002222 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002223}
2224
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002225/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2226/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2227/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2228/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2229/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2230/// false and User is unspecified.
2231///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002232/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2233/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2234/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002235static OverloadingResult
2236IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2237 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2238 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2239 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002240 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2241 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2242
2243 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2244 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002245 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002246 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2247 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2248 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2249 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2250 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2251 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2252 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2253 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002254 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002255 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002256 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002257 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2258
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002259 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2260 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2261 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2262 // to try to recover.
2263 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002264 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2265 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2266 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002267 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002268 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002269 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002270 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2271 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2272
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002273 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2274 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2275 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002276 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002277 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002278 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002279 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2280 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002281 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002282
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002283 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002284 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002285 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002286 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2287 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002288 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002289 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2290 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002291 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002292 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2293 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002294 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2295 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2296 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2297 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002298 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002299 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002300 }
2301 }
2302
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002303 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2304 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002305 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2306 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002307 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002309 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002311 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2312 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002313 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002314 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002315 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002316 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002317 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2318 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002319 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2320 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2321 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2322
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002323 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2324 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002325 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2326 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002327 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002328 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002329
2330 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2331 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002332 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2333 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2334 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002335 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002336 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2337 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002338 }
2339 }
2340 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002341 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002342
2343 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002344 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002345 case OR_Success:
2346 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2347 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2348 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002349 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2350
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002351 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2352 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2353 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2354 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2355 // the argument of the constructor.
2356 //
2357 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2358 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2359 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2360 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002361 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002362 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002363 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002364 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002365 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002366 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2367 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2368 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2369 return OR_Success;
2370 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2371 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002372 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2373
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002374 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2375 //
2376 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2377 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2378 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2379 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2380 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2381 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002382 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002383 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002384
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002385 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2386 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2387 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2388 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2389 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2390 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2391 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2392 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2393 // 13.3.3.1).
2394 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2395 return OR_Success;
2396 } else {
2397 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002398 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002399 }
2400
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002401 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2402 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2403 case OR_Deleted:
2404 // No conversion here! We're done.
2405 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002406
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002407 case OR_Ambiguous:
2408 return OR_Ambiguous;
2409 }
2410
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002411 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002412}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002413
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002414bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002415Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002416 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002417 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002418 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002419 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002420 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002421 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2422 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2423 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2424 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2425 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2426 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2427 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2428 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2429 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002430 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002431 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002432 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002433}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002434
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002435/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2436/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2437/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002438static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2439CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2440 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2441 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002442{
2443 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2444 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2445 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2446 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2447 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2448 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2449 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2450 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002451 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002452 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2453 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2454 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2455 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2456 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002457 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2458 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2459 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2460 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002461
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002462 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2463 // the same kind.
2464 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2466
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002467 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2468 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2469 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002470 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002471 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002472 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002473 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2474 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2475 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2476 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2477 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2478 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002479 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002480 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002481 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2482 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002483 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2484 }
2485
2486 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2487}
2488
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002489static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2490 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2491 Qualifiers Quals;
2492 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002493 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002494 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002495
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002496 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2497}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002498
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002499// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2500// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2501static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2502compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2503 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2504 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2505 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2506 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2507
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002508 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002509 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2510 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2511 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2512 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2513 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2514 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2515 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002516
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002517 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2518 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2519 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2520 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2521 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2522 else
2523 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002524 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002525 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2526
2527 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2528 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2529 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2530 }
2531
2532 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2533 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2534 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2535 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2536
2537 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2538 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2539 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2540 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002541
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002542 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2543}
2544
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002545/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2546/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2547static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2548 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2549 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2550 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2551 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002552 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002553 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002554 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002555 // reference*.
2556 //
2557 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2558 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2559 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2560 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2561 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00002562 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2563 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2564 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002565
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002566 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2567 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2568 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2569 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2570}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002571
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002572/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2573/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2574/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002575static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2576CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2577 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2578 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002579{
2580 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2581 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2582
2583 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2584 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2585 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2586 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2587 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002588 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002589 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002590 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002591
2592 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2593 // defined below), or, if not that,
2594 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2595 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2596 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2597 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2598 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2599 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002600
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002601 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2602 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2603 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002604
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002605 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2606 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2607 // that is such a conversion.
2608 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2609 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2610 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2611 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2612
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002613 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2614 //
2615 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002616 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2617 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2618 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002619 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002620 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002621 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002622 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002623 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2624 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2625 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002626 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2627 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002628 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2629 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2630 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002631 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002632 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002633 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002634 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2635 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2636 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2637 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002638 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2639 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002640
2641 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2642 // conversion, if we need to.
2643 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002644 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002645 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002646 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002647
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002648 QualType FromPointee1
2649 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2650 QualType FromPointee2
2651 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002652
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002653 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002654 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002655 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002656 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2657
2658 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2659 // other, it is the better one.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002660 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2661 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002662 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002663 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002664 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002665 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002666 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2667 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002668 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002669
2670 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2671 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002672 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002673 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002674 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002675
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002676 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002677 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2678 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2679 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2680 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2681 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002682
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002683 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2684 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2685 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2686 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2687 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2688 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002689 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2690 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002691 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2692 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002693 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002694 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2695 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002696 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002697 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2698 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002699 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002700 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002701 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002702 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002703 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2704 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2705 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2706 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2707 }
2708 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002709
2710 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2711}
2712
2713/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2714/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002715/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2716ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002717CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2718 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2719 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002720 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002721 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2722 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2723 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2724 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2725 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2726 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2727 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2728 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2729
2730 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2731 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002732 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2733 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002734 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2735 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002736 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002737 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2738 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002739
2740 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2741 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002742 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002743 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2744
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002745 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2746 // for comparison.
2747 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002748 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002749 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002750 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002751
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002752 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002753 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002754 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002755 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2756 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2757 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002758 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002759 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2760 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2761 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2762 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2763 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2764 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2765 // about how the sequences rank.
2766 ;
2767 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2768 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2769 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2770 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2771 // qualifiers.
2772 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002773
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002774 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2775 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2776 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2777 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2778 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2779 // qualifiers.
2780 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002781
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002782 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2783 } else {
2784 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2785 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2786 }
2787
2788 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002789 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002790 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002791 }
2792
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002793 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2794 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2795 switch (Result) {
2796 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002797 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002798 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2799 break;
2800
2801 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2802 break;
2803
2804 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002805 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002806 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2807 break;
2808 }
2809
2810 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002811}
2812
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002813/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2814/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002815/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2816/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2817/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002818ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002819CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2820 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2821 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002822 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002823 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002824 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002825 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002826
2827 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2828 // conversion, if we need to.
2829 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002830 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002831 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002832 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002833
2834 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002835 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2836 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2837 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2838 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002839
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002840 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002841 //
2842 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2843 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002844 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002845 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002846 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002847 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2848 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2849 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2850 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002851 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002852 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002853 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002854 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002855 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002856 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002857 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002858 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002859
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002860 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002861 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002862 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002863 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002864 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002865 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2866 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002867
2868 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2869 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002870 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002871 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002872 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002873 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002874 }
2875 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2876 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
2877 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
2878 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2879 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
2880 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2881 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
2882 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2883 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
2884 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2885
2886 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
2887 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
2888 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
2889 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
2890 // Objective-C pointer types.
2891 bool FromAssignLeft
2892 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
2893 bool FromAssignRight
2894 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
2895 bool ToAssignLeft
2896 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
2897 bool ToAssignRight
2898 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
2899
2900 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
2901 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
2902 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
2903 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2904 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2905 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
2906 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2907 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2908
2909 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
2910 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
2911 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2912 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2913 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2914 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2915
2916 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
2917 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
2918 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2919 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2920 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2921 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
2922 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2923 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2924
2925 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
2926 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
2927 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2928 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2929 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2930 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002931
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002932 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2933 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2934 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2935 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
2936 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2937 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2938
2939 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2940 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
2941 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
2942 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2943 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002944 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002945 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002946
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002947 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002948 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2949 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2950 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002951 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002952 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002953 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002954 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002955 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002956 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002957 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002958 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2959 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2960 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2961 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2962 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2963 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2964 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2965 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2966 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002967 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002968 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002969 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002970 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002971 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002972 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2973 }
2974 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2975 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002976 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002977 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002978 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002979 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2980 }
2981 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002982
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002983 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002984 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002985 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2986 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2987 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002988 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2989 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2990 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002991 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002992 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002993 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2994 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002995
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002996 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002997 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
2998 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2999 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003000 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3001 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3002 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003003 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003004 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003005 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3006 }
3007 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003008
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003009 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3010}
3011
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003012/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3013/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3014/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3015/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3016/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3017/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3018/// type being initialized.
3019Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3020Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3021 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003022 bool &DerivedToBase,
3023 bool &ObjCConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003024 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3025 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3026 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3027
3028 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3029 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3030 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3031 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3032 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3033
3034 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3035 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3036 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3037 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003038 DerivedToBase = false;
3039 ObjCConversion = false;
3040 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3041 // Nothing to do.
3042 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003043 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3044 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003045 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3046 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3047 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3048 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003049 else
3050 return Ref_Incompatible;
3051
3052 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3053 // least).
3054
3055 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3056 // for comparison.
3057 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3058 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3059 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3060 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3061
3062 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3063 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3064 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3065 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3066 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3067 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3068 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
3069 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
3070 return Ref_Compatible;
3071 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3072 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3073 else
3074 return Ref_Related;
3075}
3076
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003077/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003078/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3079static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003080FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3081 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3082 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3083 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003084 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3085 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3086 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3087
3088 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3089 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3090 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3091 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3092 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3093 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3094 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3095 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3096 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3097
3098 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3099 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3100 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3101 if (ConvTemplate)
3102 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3103 else
3104 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3105
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003106 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003107 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3108 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3109 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003110
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003111 if (AllowRvalues) {
3112 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3113 bool ObjCConversion = false;
3114 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003115 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3116 DeclLoc,
3117 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3118 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3119 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
3120 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) ==
3121 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003122 continue;
3123 } else {
3124 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3125 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3126 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3127
3128 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3129 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3130 if (!RefType ||
3131 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3132 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3133 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003134 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003135
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003136 if (ConvTemplate)
3137 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003138 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003139 else
3140 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003141 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003142 }
3143
3144 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003145 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003146 case OR_Success:
3147 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3148 //
3149 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3150 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3151 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3152 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3153 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3154 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3155 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3156 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3157 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3158 return false;
3159
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003160 if (Best->Function)
3161 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003162 ICS.setUserDefined();
3163 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3164 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3165 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00003166 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003167 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3168 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3169 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3170 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3171 return true;
3172
3173 case OR_Ambiguous:
3174 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3175 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3176 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3177 if (Cand->Viable)
3178 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3179 return true;
3180
3181 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3182 case OR_Deleted:
3183 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3184 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3185 return false;
3186 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003187
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00003188 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003189}
3190
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003191/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3192/// initialization.
3193static ImplicitConversionSequence
3194TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3195 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3196 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003197 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003198 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3199
3200 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3201 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3202 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3203
3204 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3205 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3206
3207 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3208 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3209 // type of the resulting function.
3210 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3211 DeclAccessPair Found;
3212 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3213 false, Found))
3214 T2 = Fn->getType();
3215 }
3216
3217 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3218 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3219 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003220 bool ObjCConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003221 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003222 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003223 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
3224 ObjCConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003225
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003226
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003227 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003228 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3229 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3230
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003231 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003232 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003233 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3234 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3235 //
3236 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3237 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3238 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003239 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003240 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3241 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3242 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3243 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3244 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3245 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3246 ICS.setStandard();
3247 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003248 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3249 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3250 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003251 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3252 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3253 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3254 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3255 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3256 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3257 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003258 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3259 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3260 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003261 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003262 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003263
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003264 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3265 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3266 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3267 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003268 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003269 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003270
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003271 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3272 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3273 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3274 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3275 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3276 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3277 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3278 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003279 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003280 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003281 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3282 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3283 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003284 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003285 }
3286 }
3287
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003288 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3289 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003290 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003291 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003292 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3293 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3294 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3295 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3296 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3297 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3298 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003299 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3300 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003301 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003302 return ICS;
3303
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003304 // -- If the initializer expression
3305 //
3306 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
3307 // lvalue and "cv1T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
3308 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3309 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3310 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3311 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3312 ICS.setStandard();
3313 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003314 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003315 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3316 : ICK_Identity;
3317 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3318 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3319 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3320 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3321 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3322 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3323 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3324 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3325 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3326 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3327 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003328 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3329 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003330 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003331 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3332 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003333 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003334 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003335 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003336 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003337 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003338
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003339 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3340 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003341 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3342 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003343 // "cv3 T3",
3344 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003345 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003346 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003347 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003348 // class subobject).
3349 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003350 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003351 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3352 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3353 AllowExplicit)) {
3354 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3355 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3356 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3357 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003358 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003359 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3360 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3361
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00003362 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00003363 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003364
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003365 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3366 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3367 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3368 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3369 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3370 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3371 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3372 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3373 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3374 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3375 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3376 // initialization fails.
3377 return ICS;
3378 }
3379
3380 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3381 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3382 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3383 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3384 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3385 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3386 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3387 return ICS;
3388
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003389 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3390 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3391 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3392 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3393 return ICS;
3394
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003395 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003396 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3397 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3398 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3399 // underlying type of the reference according to
3400 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3401 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3402 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3403 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3404 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003405 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3406 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003407 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3408 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003409
3410 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3411 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3412 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003413 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3414 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3415 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003416 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003417 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3418 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003419 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3420 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3421 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003422 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003423 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003424
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003425 return ICS;
3426}
3427
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003428/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3429/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3430/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3431/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003432/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003433/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003434static ImplicitConversionSequence
3435TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003436 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003437 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003438 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003439 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003440 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3441 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003442 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003443
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003444 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3445 SuppressUserConversions,
3446 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003447 InOverloadResolution,
3448 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003449}
3450
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003451/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3452/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3453/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003454static ImplicitConversionSequence
3455TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003456 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003457 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3458 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3459 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003460 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3461 // const volatile object.
3462 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3463 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003464 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003465
3466 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3467 // to exit early.
3468 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003469
3470 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003471 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003472 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003473 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3474
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003475 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3476 // better have an lvalue.
3477 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3478 }
3479
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003480 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003481
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003482 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003483 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003484 // parameter is
3485 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003486 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3487 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3488 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003489 // ref-qualifier
3490 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003491 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003492 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3493 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003494 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003495 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003496 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3497 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3498 // non-constant references.
3499
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003500 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003501 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003502 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003503 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003504 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003505 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3506 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003507 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003508 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003509
3510 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3511 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003512 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003513 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3514 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3515 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003516 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003517 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003518 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003519 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3520 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003521 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003522 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003523
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003524 // Check the ref-qualifier.
3525 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3526 case RQ_None:
3527 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3528 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003529
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003530 case RQ_LValue:
3531 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3532 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003533 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003534 ImplicitParamType);
3535 return ICS;
3536 }
3537 break;
3538
3539 case RQ_RValue:
3540 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3541 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003542 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003543 ImplicitParamType);
3544 return ICS;
3545 }
3546 break;
3547 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003548
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003549 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003550 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003551 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3552 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003553 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003554 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003555 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3556 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003557 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003558 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003559 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
3560 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
3561 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003562 return ICS;
3563}
3564
3565/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3566/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3567/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003568ExprResult
3569Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003570 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003571 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003572 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003573 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003574 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003575 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003576
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003577 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003578 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003579 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3580 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003581 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003582 } else {
3583 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3584 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003585 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003586 }
3587
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003588 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3589 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003591 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
3592 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003593 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3594 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3595 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3596 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3597 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3598 if (CVR) {
3599 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3600 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3601 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3602 << From->getSourceRange();
3603 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3604 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003605 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003606 }
3607 }
3608
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003609 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003610 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003611 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003612 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003613
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003614 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3615 ExprResult FromRes =
3616 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
3617 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
3618 return ExprError();
3619 From = FromRes.take();
3620 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003621
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003622 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003623 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
3624 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
3625 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003626}
3627
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003628/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3629/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003630static ImplicitConversionSequence
3631TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003632 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003633 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003634 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3635 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003636 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003637 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3638 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003639}
3640
3641/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3642/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003643ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003644 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003645 if (!ICS.isBad())
3646 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003647
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003648 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003649 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3650 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003651 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003652 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003653}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003654
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003655/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3656/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003657static ImplicitConversionSequence
3658TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3659 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3660 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3661 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3662 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3663 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003664 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3665 /*CStyle=*/false);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003666}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003667
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003668/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3669/// of the expression From to 'id'.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003670ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003671 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003672 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003673 if (!ICS.isBad())
3674 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003675 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003676}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003677
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003678/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003679/// enumeration type.
3680///
3681/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3682/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3683/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3684///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003685/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3686/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003687///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003688/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3689///
3690/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3691/// have integral or enumeration type.
3692///
3693/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3694/// incomplete class type.
3695///
3696/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3697/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3698/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3699///
3700/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3701/// showing which conversion was picked.
3702///
3703/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3704/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3705///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003706/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003707/// usable conversion function.
3708///
3709/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3710/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3711///
3712/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3713/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003714ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003715Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003716 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3717 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3718 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3719 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3720 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003721 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3722 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003723 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3724 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003725 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003726
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003727 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3728 QualType T = From->getType();
3729 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003730 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003731
3732 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3733
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003734 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003735 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3736 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3737 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3738 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3739 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003740 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003741 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003742
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003743 // We must have a complete class type.
3744 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003745 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003746
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003747 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3748 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3749 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3750 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3751 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003752
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003753 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003754 E = Conversions->end();
3755 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003756 ++I) {
3757 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3758 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3759 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3760 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3761 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3762 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3763 else
3764 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3765 }
3766 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003767
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003768 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3769 case 0:
3770 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3771 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3772 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3773 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003774
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003775 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3776 // conversion; use it.
3777 QualType ConvTy
3778 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3779 std::string TypeStr;
3780 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003781
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003782 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3783 << T << ConvTy
3784 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3785 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3786 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3787 ")");
3788 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3789 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003790
3791 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003792 // explicit conversion function.
3793 if (isSFINAEContext())
3794 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003795
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003796 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003797 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
3798 if (Result.isInvalid())
3799 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003800
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003801 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003802 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003803
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003804 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3805 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003806
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003807 case 1: {
3808 // Apply this conversion.
3809 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3810 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003811
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003812 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3813 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3814 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003815 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003816 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3817 if (isSFINAEContext())
3818 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003819
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003820 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3821 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3822 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003823
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003824 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003825 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003826 if (Result.isInvalid())
3827 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003828
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003829 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003830 break;
3831 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003832
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003833 default:
3834 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3835 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3836 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3837 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3838 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3839 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3840 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3841 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3842 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003843 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003844 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003845
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003846 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003847 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3848 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003849
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003850 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003851}
3852
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003853/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003854/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3855/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3856/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003857///
3858/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3859/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3860/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003861void
3862Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003863 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003864 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003865 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003866 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003867 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003868 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003869 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003870 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003871 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003872 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003873
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003874 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003875 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3876 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3877 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3878 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3879 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003880 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3881 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3882 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003883 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003884 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003885 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003886 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003887 return;
3888 }
3889 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3890 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003891 }
3892
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003893 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003894 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003895
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003896 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003897 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003898
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003899 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3900 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3901 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3902 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3903 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003904 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00003905 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003906 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3907 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003908 return;
3909 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003910
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003911 // Add this candidate
3912 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3913 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003914 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003915 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003916 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003917 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003918 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00003919 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003920
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003921 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3922
3923 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3924 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3925 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003926 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003927 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003928 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003929 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003930 return;
3931 }
3932
3933 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3934 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3935 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3936 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3937 // exactly m parameters.
3938 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003939 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003940 // Not enough arguments.
3941 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003942 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003943 return;
3944 }
3945
3946 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3947 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003948 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3949 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3950 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3951 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3952 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3953 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3954 // parameter of F.
3955 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003956 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003957 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003958 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003959 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003960 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3961 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003962 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003963 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003964 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003965 } else {
3966 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3967 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3968 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003969 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003970 }
3971 }
3972}
3973
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003974/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3975/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003976void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003977 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3978 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3979 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003980 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003981 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3982 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003983 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003984 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003985 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003986 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003987 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003988 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3989 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003990 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003991 SuppressUserConversions);
3992 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003993 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003994 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3995 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003996 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003997 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003998 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003999 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004000 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
4001 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004002 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004003 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004004 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004005 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004006 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004007 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4008 SuppressUserConversions);
4009 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004010 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004011}
4012
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004013/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
4014/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004015void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004016 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004017 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004018 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4019 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004020 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004021 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004022 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004023
4024 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
4025 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004026
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004027 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
4028 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4029 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004030 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4031 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004032 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004033 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004034 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004035 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004036 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004037 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004038 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004039 }
4040}
4041
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004042/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4043/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4044/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4045/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4046/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4047/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004048/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004049void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004050Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004051 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004052 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004053 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004054 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004055 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004056 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004057 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004058 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004059 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4060 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004061
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004062 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4063 return;
4064
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004065 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004066 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004067
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004068 // Add this candidate
4069 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4070 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004071 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004072 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004073 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004074 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004075 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004076
4077 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4078
4079 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4080 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4081 // list (8.3.5).
4082 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4083 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004084 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004085 return;
4086 }
4087
4088 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4089 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4090 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4091 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4092 // exactly m parameters.
4093 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4094 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4095 // Not enough arguments.
4096 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004097 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004098 return;
4099 }
4100
4101 Candidate.Viable = true;
4102 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4103
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004104 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004105 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4106 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4107 else {
4108 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4109 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004110 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004111 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4112 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004113 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004114 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004115 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004116 return;
4117 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004118 }
4119
4120 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4121 // arguments.
4122 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4123 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4124 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4125 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4126 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4127 // parameter of F.
4128 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004129 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004130 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004131 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00004132 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004133 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004134 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004135 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004136 break;
4137 }
4138 } else {
4139 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4140 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4141 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004142 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004143 }
4144 }
4145}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004146
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004147/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4148/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4149/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004150void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004151Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004152 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004153 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004154 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004155 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004156 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004157 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004158 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004159 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004160 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4161 return;
4162
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004163 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004164 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004165 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004166 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004167 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4168 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4169 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4170 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4171 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004172 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004173 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4174 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004175 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004176 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004177 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4178 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4179 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4180 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4181 Candidate.Viable = false;
4182 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4183 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4184 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004185 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004186 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004187 Info);
4188 return;
4189 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004190
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004191 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4192 // deduction as a candidate.
4193 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004194 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004195 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004196 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004197 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4198 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004199}
4200
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004201/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4202/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4203/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004204void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004205Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004206 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004207 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004208 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4209 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004210 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004211 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4212 return;
4213
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004214 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004215 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004216 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004217 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004218 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4219 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4220 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4221 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4222 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004223 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004224 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4225 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004226 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004227 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004228 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4229 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004230 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004231 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4232 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004233 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004234 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4235 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004236 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004237 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004238 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004239 return;
4240 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004241
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004242 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4243 // deduction as a candidate.
4244 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004245 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004246 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004247}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004248
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004249/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004250/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004251/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004252/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004253/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4254/// conversion function produces).
4255void
4256Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004257 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004258 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004259 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4260 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004261 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4262 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004263 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004264 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4265 return;
4266
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004267 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004268 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004269
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004270 // Add this candidate
4271 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4272 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004273 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004274 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004275 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004276 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004277 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004278 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004279 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004280 Candidate.Viable = true;
4281 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004282 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004283
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004284 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004285 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4286 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004287 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004288 //
4289 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4290 // object parameter.
4291 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4292 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4293 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4294 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4295 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004296
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004297 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004298 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4299 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004300 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004301
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004302 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004303 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004304 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004305 return;
4306 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004307
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004308 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004309 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4310 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4311 QualType FromCanon
4312 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4313 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4314 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4315 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004316 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004317 return;
4318 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004319
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004320 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4321 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4322 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4323 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4324 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4325 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4326 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4327 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004328 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004329 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004330 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4331 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004332 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00004333 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004334
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00004335 QualType CallResultType
4336 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
4337 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) {
4338 Candidate.Viable = false;
4339 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4340 return;
4341 }
4342
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004343 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType());
4344
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004345 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004346 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4347 // allocator).
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004348 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00004349 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004350 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004351 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004352 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004353 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004354
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004355 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004356 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4357 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004358
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004359 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4360 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004361 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004362 // shall have exact match rank.
4363 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4364 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4365 Candidate.Viable = false;
4366 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4367 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004368
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004369 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4370 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4371 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4372 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4373 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004374 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004375 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4376 Candidate.Viable = false;
4377 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4378 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004379 break;
4380
4381 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4382 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004383 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004384 break;
4385
4386 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004387 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004388 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4389 }
4390}
4391
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004392/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4393/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4394/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4395/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4396/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004397void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004398Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004399 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004400 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004401 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4402 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4403 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4404 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4405
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004406 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4407 return;
4408
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004409 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004410 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4411 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004412 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004413 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004414 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4415 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4416 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4417 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4418 Candidate.Viable = false;
4419 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4420 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4421 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004422 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004423 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004424 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004425 return;
4426 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004427
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004428 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4429 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4430 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004431 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004432 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004433}
4434
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004435/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4436/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4437/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4438/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4439/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4440void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004441 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004442 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004443 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004444 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004445 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004446 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004447 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4448 return;
4449
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004450 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004451 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004452
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004453 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4454 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004455 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004456 Candidate.Function = 0;
4457 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4458 Candidate.Viable = true;
4459 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004460 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004461 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004462 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004463
4464 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4465 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004466 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004467 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004468 Object->Classify(Context),
4469 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004470 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004471 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004472 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004473 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004474 return;
4475 }
4476
4477 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4478 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4479 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004480 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004481 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004482 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004483 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004484 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00004485 = FoundDecl.getDecl();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004486 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004487 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4488 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4489
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004490 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004491 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4492
4493 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4494 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4495 // list (8.3.5).
4496 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4497 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004498 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004499 return;
4500 }
4501
4502 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4503 // we have enough arguments.
4504 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4505 // Not enough arguments.
4506 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004507 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004508 return;
4509 }
4510
4511 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4512 // arguments.
4513 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4514 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4515 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4516 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4517 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4518 // parameter of F.
4519 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004520 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004521 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004522 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004523 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004524 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004525 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004526 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004527 break;
4528 }
4529 } else {
4530 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4531 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4532 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004533 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004534 }
4535 }
4536}
4537
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004538/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4539/// member functions.
4540///
4541/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4542/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4543/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4544/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4545/// [over.match.oper]).
4546void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4547 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4548 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4549 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4550 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004551 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4552
4553 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4554 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4555 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4556 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4557 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4558 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4559 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4560 // constructed as follows:
4561 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004562
4563 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4564 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4565 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4566 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004567 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004568 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004569 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004570 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004571
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004572 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4573 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4574 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4575
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004576 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004577 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4578 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004579 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004580 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004581 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004582 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004583 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004584 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004585}
4586
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004587/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4588/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4589/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004590/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4591/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004592/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4593/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4594/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004595void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004596 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004597 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004598 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4599 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004600 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004601 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004602
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004603 // Add this candidate
4604 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4605 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004606 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004607 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004608 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004609 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004610 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4611 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4612 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4613
4614 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4615 // arguments.
4616 Candidate.Viable = true;
4617 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004618 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004619 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004620 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4621 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4622 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4623 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4624 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4625 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004626 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004627 //
4628 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4629 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4630 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4631 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004632 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004633 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004634 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004635 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4636 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004637 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004638 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004639 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004640 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004641 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004642 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004643 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004644 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004645 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004646 break;
4647 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004648 }
4649}
4650
4651/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4652/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4653/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4654/// enumeration types.
4655class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4656 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004657 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004658
4659 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4660 /// built-in candidates.
4661 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4662
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004663 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4664 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4665 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4666
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004667 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4668 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4669 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4670
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004671 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004672 /// candidates.
4673 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004674
4675 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4676 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4677
4678 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4679 /// were present in the candidate set.
4680 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4681
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004682 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4683 /// candidate type set.
4684 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004685
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004686 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4687 ASTContext &Context;
4688
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004689 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4690 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004691 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004692
4693public:
4694 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004695 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004696
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004697 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004698 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4699 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
4700 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4701 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004702
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004703 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004704 SourceLocation Loc,
4705 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004706 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4707 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004708
4709 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4710 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4711
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004712 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004713 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4714
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004715 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4716 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4717
4718 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4719 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4720
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004721 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4722 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4723
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004724 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004725 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004726
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004727 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4728 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004729
4730 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
4731 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004732};
4733
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004734/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004735/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4736/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4737/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4738/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4739/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4740/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004741///
4742/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004743bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004744BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4745 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004746
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004747 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004748 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004749 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004750
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004751 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004752 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004753 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004754 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004755 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004756 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004757 buildObjCPtr = true;
4758 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004759 else
4760 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4761 }
4762 else
4763 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004764
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004765 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4766 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4767 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4768 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4769 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4770 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004771 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004772 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004773 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004774 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4775 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004776
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004777 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4778 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4779 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004780 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4781 // in the types.
4782 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4783 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004784 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004785 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4786 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
4787 else
4788 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004789 }
4790
4791 return true;
4792}
4793
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004794/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4795/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4796/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4797/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4798/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4799/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4800/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004801///
4802/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004803bool
4804BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4805 QualType Ty) {
4806 // Insert this type.
4807 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4808 return false;
4809
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004810 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4811 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004812
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004813 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004814 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4815 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4816 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4817 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4818 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4819 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004820 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4821
4822 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4823 // qualifiers.
4824 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4825 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4826 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004827
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004828 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004829 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
4830 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004831 }
4832
4833 return true;
4834}
4835
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004836/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4837/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004838/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4839/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004840/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4841/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4842/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4843/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004844void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004845BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004846 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004847 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004848 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4849 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004850 // Only deal with canonical types.
4851 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4852
4853 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4854 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004855 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004856 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4857
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004858 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4859 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4860 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
4861
4862 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004863 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004864
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004865 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
4866 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
4867 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
4868
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004869 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
4870 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
4871 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
4872
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004873 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
4874 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
4875 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004876 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4877 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004878 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004879 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004880 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4881 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4882 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4883 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004884 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004885 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004886 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004887 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004888 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
4889 // extension.
4890 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004891 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004892 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
4893 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4894 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
4895 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004896
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004897 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
4898 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4899 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4900 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
4901 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
4902 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4903 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4904 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004905
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004906 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
4907 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
4908 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
4909 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004910
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004911 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4912 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
4913 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
4914 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004915 }
4916 }
4917 }
4918}
4919
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004920/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4921/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4922/// given type to the candidate set.
4923static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4924 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004925 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004926 unsigned NumArgs,
4927 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4928 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004929
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004930 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4931 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4932 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4933 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4934 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004935
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004936 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4937 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004938 ParamTypes[0]
4939 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004940 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4941 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004942 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004943 }
4944}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004945
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004946/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4947/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004948static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4949 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4950 const RecordType *TyRec;
4951 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4952 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004953 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004954 else
4955 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4956 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004957 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004958 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4959 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4960 return VRQuals;
4961 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004962
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004963 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004964 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4965 return VRQuals;
4966
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004967 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004968 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004969
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004970 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004971 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004972 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4973 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4974 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4975 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004976 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4977 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4978 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4979 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4980 // as see them.
4981 bool done = false;
4982 while (!done) {
4983 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4984 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004985 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004986 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4987 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4988 else
4989 done = true;
4990 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4991 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4992 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4993 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4994 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
4995 return VRQuals;
4996 }
4997 }
4998 }
4999 return VRQuals;
5000}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005001
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005002namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005003
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005004/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
5005/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
5006/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
5007/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
5008class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005009 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
5010 Sema &S;
5011 Expr **Args;
5012 unsigned NumArgs;
5013 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005014 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005015 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
5016 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005017
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005018 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
5019 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005020 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
5021 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005022 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
5023 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
5024 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
5025 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
5026 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
5027 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
5028 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
5029
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005030 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
5031 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
5032 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
5033 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5034 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5035 // Start of promoted types.
5036 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5037 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5038 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005039
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005040 // Start of integral types.
5041 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5042 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5043 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5044 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5045 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5046 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5047 // End of promoted types.
5048
5049 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5050 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5051 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5052 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5053 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5054 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5055 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5056 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5057 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5058 // End of integral types.
5059 // FIXME: What about complex?
5060 };
5061 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5062 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005063
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005064 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5065 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5066 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5067 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5068 // The rules are basically:
5069 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5070 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5071 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5072 // - use the larger type
5073 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5074 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5075 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5076 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5077 // better not to make any assumptions).
5078 enum PromotedType {
5079 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
5080 };
5081 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5082 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5083 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5084 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5085 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5086 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5087 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5088 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5089 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5090 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5091 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
5092 };
5093
5094 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5095 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5096 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5097
5098 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005099 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005100
5101 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5102 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005103 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5104 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005105 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5106 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5107
5108 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5109 if (LW > RW) return LT;
5110 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5111
5112 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5113 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5114 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5115 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5116 }
5117
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00005118 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5119 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005120 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5121 bool HasVolatile) {
5122 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5123 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5124 S.Context.IntTy
5125 };
5126
5127 // Non-volatile version.
5128 if (NumArgs == 1)
5129 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5130 else
5131 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5132
5133 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5134 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5135 if (HasVolatile) {
5136 ParamTypes[0] =
5137 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5138 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5139 if (NumArgs == 1)
5140 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5141 else
5142 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5143 }
5144 }
5145
5146public:
5147 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5148 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5149 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005150 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005151 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
5152 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5153 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5154 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005155 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5156 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005157 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5158 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5159 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005160 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005161 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005162 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5163 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005164 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005165 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5166 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005167 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005168 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5169 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005170 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5171 }
5172
5173 // C++ [over.built]p3:
5174 //
5175 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5176 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5177 // functions of the form
5178 //
5179 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
5180 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
5181 //
5182 // C++ [over.built]p4:
5183 //
5184 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5185 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5186 // candidate operator functions of the form
5187 //
5188 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
5189 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
5190 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005191 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5192 return;
5193
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005194 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5195 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5196 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005197 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005198 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5199 }
5200 }
5201
5202 // C++ [over.built]p5:
5203 //
5204 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5205 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5206 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5207 //
5208 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
5209 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
5210 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5211 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5212 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5213 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5214 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5215 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5216 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5217 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005218 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005219 continue;
5220
5221 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5222 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5223 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5224 }
5225 }
5226
5227 // C++ [over.built]p6:
5228 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5229 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5230 //
5231 // T& operator*(T*);
5232 //
5233 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005234 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005235 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005236 // T& operator*(T*);
5237 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5238 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5239 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5240 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5241 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5242 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5243 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005244 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5245 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005246
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005247 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5248 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5249 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005250
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005251 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5252 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5253 }
5254 }
5255
5256 // C++ [over.built]p9:
5257 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5258 // operator functions of the form
5259 //
5260 // T operator+(T);
5261 // T operator-(T);
5262 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005263 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5264 return;
5265
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005266 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5267 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005268 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005269 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5270 }
5271
5272 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5273 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5274 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5275 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5276 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5277 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5278 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5279 }
5280 }
5281
5282 // C++ [over.built]p8:
5283 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5284 // the form
5285 //
5286 // T* operator+(T*);
5287 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5288 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5289 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5290 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5291 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5292 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5293 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5294 }
5295 }
5296
5297 // C++ [over.built]p10:
5298 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5299 // operator functions of the form
5300 //
5301 // T operator~(T);
5302 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005303 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5304 return;
5305
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005306 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5307 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005308 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005309 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5310 }
5311
5312 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5313 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5314 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5315 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5316 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5317 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5318 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5319 }
5320 }
5321
5322 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5323 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5324 // functions of the form
5325 //
5326 // bool operator==(T,T);
5327 // bool operator!=(T,T);
5328 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5329 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5330 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5331
5332 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5333 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5334 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5335 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5336 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5337 ++MemPtr) {
5338 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5339 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5340 continue;
5341
5342 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5343 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5344 CandidateSet);
5345 }
5346 }
5347 }
5348
5349 // C++ [over.built]p15:
5350 //
5351 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
5352 // candidate operator functions of the form
5353 //
5354 // bool operator<(T, T);
5355 // bool operator>(T, T);
5356 // bool operator<=(T, T);
5357 // bool operator>=(T, T);
5358 // bool operator==(T, T);
5359 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005360 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5361 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5362 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5363 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5364 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5365 // functions.
5366 //
5367 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5368 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5369 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5370 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5371 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5372 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5373 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5374 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5375 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5376
5377 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5378 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5379 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5380 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5381 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5382 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5383 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5384 continue;
5385
5386 QualType FirstParamType =
5387 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5388 QualType SecondParamType =
5389 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5390
5391 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5392 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5393 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5394 continue;
5395
5396 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5397 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5398 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5399 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5400 }
5401 }
5402 }
5403
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005404 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5405 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5406
5407 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5408 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5409 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5410 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5411 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5412 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5413 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5414 continue;
5415
5416 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5417 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5418 CandidateSet);
5419 }
5420 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5421 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5422 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5423 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5424 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5425
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005426 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5427 // candidate exists.
5428 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5429 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5430 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005431 continue;
5432
5433 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005434 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5435 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005436 }
5437 }
5438 }
5439
5440 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5441 //
5442 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5443 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5444 //
5445 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5446 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5447 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5448 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5449 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5450 //
5451 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5452 //
5453 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5454 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5455 //
5456 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5457 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5458 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5459 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5460
5461 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5462 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5463 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5464 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5465 };
5466 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5467 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5468 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5469 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005470 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5471 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5472 continue;
5473
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005474 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5475 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5476 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5477 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5478 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5479 CandidateSet);
5480 }
5481 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5482 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5483 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5484 continue;
5485
5486 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5487 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5488 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5489 }
5490 }
5491 }
5492 }
5493
5494 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5495 //
5496 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5497 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5498 //
5499 // LR operator*(L, R);
5500 // LR operator/(L, R);
5501 // LR operator+(L, R);
5502 // LR operator-(L, R);
5503 // bool operator<(L, R);
5504 // bool operator>(L, R);
5505 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5506 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5507 // bool operator==(L, R);
5508 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5509 //
5510 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5511 // between types L and R.
5512 //
5513 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5514 //
5515 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5516 // candidate operator functions of the form
5517 //
5518 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5519 //
5520 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5521 // between types L and R.
5522 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5523 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005524 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5525 return;
5526
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005527 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5528 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5529 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5530 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005531 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5532 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005533 QualType Result =
5534 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005535 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005536 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5537 }
5538 }
5539
5540 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5541 // conditional operator for vector types.
5542 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5543 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5544 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5545 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5546 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5547 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5548 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5549 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5550 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5551 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5552 if (!isComparison) {
5553 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5554 Result = *Vec1;
5555 else
5556 Result = *Vec2;
5557 }
5558
5559 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5560 }
5561 }
5562 }
5563
5564 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5565 //
5566 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5567 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5568 //
5569 // LR operator%(L, R);
5570 // LR operator&(L, R);
5571 // LR operator^(L, R);
5572 // LR operator|(L, R);
5573 // L operator<<(L, R);
5574 // L operator>>(L, R);
5575 //
5576 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5577 // between types L and R.
5578 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005579 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5580 return;
5581
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005582 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5583 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5584 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5585 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005586 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5587 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005588 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5589 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005590 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005591 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5592 }
5593 }
5594 }
5595
5596 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5597 //
5598 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5599 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5600 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5601 //
5602 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5603 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5604 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5605 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5606
5607 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5608 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5609 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5610 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5611 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5612 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5613 continue;
5614
5615 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5616 CandidateSet);
5617 }
5618
5619 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5620 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5621 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5622 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5623 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5624 continue;
5625
5626 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5627 CandidateSet);
5628 }
5629 }
5630 }
5631
5632 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5633 //
5634 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5635 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5636 // of the form
5637 //
5638 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5639 //
5640 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5641 //
5642 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5643 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5644 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5645 //
5646 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5647 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5648 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5649 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5650 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5651
5652 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5653 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5654 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5655 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5656 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5657 if (isEqualOp)
5658 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005659 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5660 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005661
5662 // non-volatile version
5663 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5664 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5665 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5666 };
5667 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5668 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5669
5670 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5671 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5672 // volatile version
5673 ParamTypes[0] =
5674 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5675 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5676 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5677 }
5678 }
5679
5680 if (isEqualOp) {
5681 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5682 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5683 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5684 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5685 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5686 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5687 continue;
5688
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005689 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5690 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5691 *Ptr,
5692 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005693
5694 // non-volatile version
5695 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5696 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5697
5698 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5699 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5700 // volatile version
5701 ParamTypes[0] =
5702 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005703 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5704 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005705 }
5706 }
5707 }
5708 }
5709
5710 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5711 //
5712 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5713 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5714 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5715 // the form
5716 //
5717 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5718 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5719 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5720 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5721 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5722 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005723 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5724 return;
5725
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005726 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5727 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5728 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5729 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005730 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005731
5732 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5733 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005734 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005735 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5736 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5737
5738 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5739 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5740 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005741 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005742 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005743 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5744 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005745 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5746 }
5747 }
5748 }
5749
5750 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5751 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5752 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5753 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5754 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5755 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5756 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5757 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5758 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5759 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5760 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5761 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5762 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5763 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5764 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5765
5766 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5767 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5768 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5769 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005770 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5771 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005772 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5773 }
5774 }
5775 }
5776 }
5777
5778 // C++ [over.built]p22:
5779 //
5780 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
5781 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
5782 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5783 //
5784 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
5785 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
5786 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
5787 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
5788 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
5789 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
5790 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005791 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5792 return;
5793
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005794 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
5795 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5796 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5797 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005798 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005799
5800 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5801 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005802 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005803 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5804 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5805 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005806 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005807 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
5808 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
5809 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5810 CandidateSet);
5811 }
5812 }
5813 }
5814 }
5815
5816 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
5817 //
5818 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
5819 //
5820 // bool operator!(bool);
5821 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
5822 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
5823 void addExclaimOverload() {
5824 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
5825 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
5826 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5827 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
5828 }
5829 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
5830 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
5831 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5832 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5833 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
5834 }
5835
5836 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5837 //
5838 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
5839 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5840 //
5841 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5842 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5843 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5844 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5845 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5846 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
5847 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5848 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5849 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5850 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5851 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
5852 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005853 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5854 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005855
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005856 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5857
5858 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5859 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5860 }
5861
5862 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5863 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5864 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5865 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5866 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
5867 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005868 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5869 continue;
5870
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005871 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5872
5873 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
5874 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5875 }
5876 }
5877
5878 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5879 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5880 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5881 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5882 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5883 //
5884 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5885 //
5886 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5887 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
5888 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5889 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5890 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5891 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5892 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5893 QualType C1;
5894 QualifierCollector Q1;
5895 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
5896 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5897 continue;
5898 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5899 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5900 // volatile/restrict type.
5901 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5902 continue;
5903 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5904 continue;
5905 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5906 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
5907 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
5908 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5909 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5910 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
5911 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
5912 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5913 break;
5914 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5915 // build CV12 T&
5916 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
5917 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5918 T.isVolatileQualified())
5919 continue;
5920 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5921 T.isRestrictQualified())
5922 continue;
5923 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
5924 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5925 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5926 }
5927 }
5928 }
5929
5930 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5931 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5932 // therefore added as binary.
5933 //
5934 // C++ [over.built]p25:
5935 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
5936 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5937 //
5938 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5939 //
5940 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
5941 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5942 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5943
5944 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5945 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5946 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5947 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5948 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5949 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5950 continue;
5951
5952 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5953 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5954 }
5955
5956 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5957 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5958 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5959 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5960 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5961 continue;
5962
5963 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5964 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5965 }
5966
5967 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
5968 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5969 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5970 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5971 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5972 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
5973 continue;
5974
5975 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5976 continue;
5977
5978 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5979 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5980 }
5981 }
5982 }
5983 }
5984};
5985
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005986} // end anonymous namespace
5987
5988/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
5989/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
5990/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
5991/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
5992/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
5993void
5994Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5995 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5996 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5997 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005998 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
5999 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006000 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
6001 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006002 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
6003 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00006004 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6005 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006006
6007 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
6008 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006009 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
6010 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6011 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
6012 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
6013 OpLoc,
6014 true,
6015 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
6016 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
6017 Op == OO_PipePipe),
6018 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006019 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
6020 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
6021 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
6022 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
6023 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006024 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006025
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006026 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
6027 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
6028 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
6029 return;
6030
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006031 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
6032 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
6033 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006034 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006035 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
6036
6037 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006038 switch (Op) {
6039 case OO_None:
6040 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
6041 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
6042 break;
6043
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006044 case OO_New:
6045 case OO_Delete:
6046 case OO_Array_New:
6047 case OO_Array_Delete:
6048 case OO_Call:
6049 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
6050 break;
6051
6052 case OO_Comma:
6053 case OO_Arrow:
6054 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6055 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6056 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006057 break;
6058
6059 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006060 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006061 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006062 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006063
6064 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006065 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006066 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006067 } else {
6068 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6069 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6070 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006071 break;
6072
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006073 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006074 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006075 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6076 else
6077 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6078 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006079
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006080 case OO_Slash:
6081 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006082 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006083
6084 case OO_PlusPlus:
6085 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006086 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6087 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006088 break;
6089
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006090 case OO_EqualEqual:
6091 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006092 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006093 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006094
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006095 case OO_Less:
6096 case OO_Greater:
6097 case OO_LessEqual:
6098 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006099 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006100 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6101 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006102
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006103 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006104 case OO_Caret:
6105 case OO_Pipe:
6106 case OO_LessLess:
6107 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006108 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006109 break;
6110
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006111 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6112 if (NumArgs == 1)
6113 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6114 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6115 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6116 break;
6117
6118 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6119 break;
6120
6121 case OO_Tilde:
6122 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6123 break;
6124
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006125 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006126 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006127 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006128
6129 case OO_PlusEqual:
6130 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006131 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006132 // Fall through.
6133
6134 case OO_StarEqual:
6135 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006136 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006137 break;
6138
6139 case OO_PercentEqual:
6140 case OO_LessLessEqual:
6141 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6142 case OO_AmpEqual:
6143 case OO_CaretEqual:
6144 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006145 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006146 break;
6147
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006148 case OO_Exclaim:
6149 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006150 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006151
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006152 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006153 case OO_PipePipe:
6154 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006155 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006156
6157 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006158 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006159 break;
6160
6161 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006162 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006163 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006164
6165 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006166 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006167 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6168 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006169 }
6170}
6171
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006172/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6173/// to the set of overloading candidates.
6174///
6175/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6176/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6177/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6178/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006179void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006180Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006181 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006182 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006183 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006184 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006185 bool PartialOverloading,
6186 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006187 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006188
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00006189 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6190 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6191 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
6192 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6193 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
6194 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6195
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006196 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006197 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
6198 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006199
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006200 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006201 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6202 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6203 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006204 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006205 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006206 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006207 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006208 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006209
6210 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6211 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006212 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006213 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006214 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006215 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006216 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006217
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006218 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006219 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006220 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006221 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006222 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00006223 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006224 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006225}
6226
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006227/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6228/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006229bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006230isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006231 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6232 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006233 SourceLocation Loc,
6234 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006235 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6236 // functions.
6237 if (!Cand2.Viable)
6238 return Cand1.Viable;
6239 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6240 return false;
6241
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006242 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6243 //
6244 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6245 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6246 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6247 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6248 unsigned StartArg = 0;
6249 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6250 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006251
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006252 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006253 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6254 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006255 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006256 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6257 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6258 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006259 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006260 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6261 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006262 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6263 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6264 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6265 HasBetterConversion = true;
6266 break;
6267
6268 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6269 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6270 return false;
6271
6272 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6273 // Do nothing.
6274 break;
6275 }
6276 }
6277
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006278 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006279 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006280 if (HasBetterConversion)
6281 return true;
6282
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006283 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006284 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00006285 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006286 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6287 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006288
6289 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6290 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6291 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006292 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00006293 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006294 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006295 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006296 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6297 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6298 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006299 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00006300 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006301 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006302 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006303 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006304
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006305 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6306 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6307 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6308 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6309 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6310 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006311 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006312 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006313 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006314 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6315 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006316 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6317 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6318 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6319 return true;
6320
6321 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6322 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6323 return false;
6324
6325 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6326 // Do nothing
6327 break;
6328 }
6329 }
6330
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006331 return false;
6332}
6333
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006334/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006335/// within an overload candidate set.
6336///
6337/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6338///
6339/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6340/// which overload resolution occurs.
6341///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006342/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006343/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6344///
6345/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006346OverloadingResult
6347OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006348 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00006349 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006350 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006351 Best = end();
6352 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6353 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006354 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006355 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006356 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006357 }
6358
6359 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006360 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006361 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6362
6363 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6364 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006365 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006366 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006367 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006368 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006369 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006370 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006371 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006372 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006373 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006374
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006375 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006376 if (Best->Function &&
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006377 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || Best->Function->isUnavailable()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006378 return OR_Deleted;
6379
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006380 return OR_Success;
6381}
6382
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006383namespace {
6384
6385enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6386 oc_function,
6387 oc_method,
6388 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006389 oc_function_template,
6390 oc_method_template,
6391 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006392 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6393 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006394 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
6395 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006396};
6397
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006398OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6399 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6400 std::string &Description) {
6401 bool isTemplate = false;
6402
6403 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6404 isTemplate = true;
6405 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6406 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6407 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006408
6409 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006410 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006411 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006412
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006413 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6414 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6415
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006416 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
6417 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006418 }
6419
6420 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6421 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6422 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006423 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006424 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006425
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006426 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006427 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006428 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6429 }
6430
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006431 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006432}
6433
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006434void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6435 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6436 if (!Ctor) return;
6437
6438 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6439 if (!Ctor) return;
6440
6441 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6442}
6443
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006444} // end anonymous namespace
6445
6446// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6447void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006448 std::string FnDesc;
6449 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6450 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6451 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006452 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006453}
6454
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00006455//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6456// OverloadedExpr
6457void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6458 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6459
6460 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6461 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6462
6463 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6464 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6465 I != IEnd; ++I) {
6466 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
6467 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6468 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
6469 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
6470 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6471 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
6472 }
6473 }
6474}
6475
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006476/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6477/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6478/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006479void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6480 Sema &S,
6481 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6482 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6483 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6484 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006485 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006486 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6487 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006488 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006489}
6490
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006491namespace {
6492
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006493void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6494 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6495 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006496 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6497 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6498
6499 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6500 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6501 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006502 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006503 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006504 if (I == 0)
6505 isObjectArgument = true;
6506 else
6507 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006508 }
6509
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006510 std::string FnDesc;
6511 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6512
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006513 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6514 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6515 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006516
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006517 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006518 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006519 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6520 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6521 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006522 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006523
6524 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6525 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6526 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6527 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006528 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006529 return;
6530 }
6531
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006532 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6533 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006534 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6535 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6536 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6537 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6538 else {
6539 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6540 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6541 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6542 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6543 }
6544
6545 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6546 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6547 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6548 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6549 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6550 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6551 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6552
6553 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6554 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6555
6556 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6557 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6558 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6559 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6560 << FromTy
6561 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6562 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006563 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006564 return;
6565 }
6566
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00006567 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
6568 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
6569 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6570 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6571 << FromTy
6572 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
6573 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6574 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6575 return;
6576 }
6577
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006578 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6579 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6580
6581 if (isObjectArgument) {
6582 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6583 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6584 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6585 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6586 } else {
6587 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6588 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6589 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6590 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6591 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006592 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006593 return;
6594 }
6595
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006596 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6597 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6598 // the failure.
6599 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6600 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6601 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6602 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6603 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6604 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6605 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6606 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006607 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006608 return;
6609 }
6610
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006611 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006612 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006613 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6614 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6615 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6616 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6617 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6618 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006619 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006620 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006621 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006622 }
6623 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6624 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6625 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6626 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6627 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6628 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6629 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6630 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6631 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006632 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6633 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6634 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6635 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6636 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6637 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6638 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6639 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006640
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006641 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006642 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006643 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006644 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6645 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006646 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006647 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006648 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006649 return;
6650 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006651
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006652 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006653 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
6654 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006655 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00006656 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006657 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006658}
6659
6660void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6661 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
6662 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
6663
6664 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6665 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6666
6667 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006668
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006669 // at least / at most / exactly
6670 unsigned mode, modeCount;
6671 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006672 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
6673 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6674 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006675 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00006676 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006677 mode = 0; // "at least"
6678 else
6679 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6680 modeCount = MinParams;
6681 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006682 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
6683 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6684 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006685 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
6686 mode = 1; // "at most"
6687 else
6688 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6689 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
6690 }
6691
6692 std::string Description;
6693 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
6694
6695 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006696 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006697 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006698 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006699}
6700
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006701/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
6702void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6703 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6704 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
6705
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006706 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006707 NamedDecl *ParamD;
6708 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
6709 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
6710 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006711 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
6712 case Sema::TDK_Success:
6713 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
6714
6715 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006716 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
6717 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
6718 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006719 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006720 return;
6721 }
6722
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006723 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
6724 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
6725 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
6726
6727 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
6728
6729 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
6730 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006731 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006732 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006733 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006734 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
6735
6736 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
6737 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
6738 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
6739 // done on dependent types).
6740 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
6741
6742 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
6743 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006744 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006745 return;
6746 }
6747
6748 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006749 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006750 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006751 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006752 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006753 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006754 which = 1;
6755 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006756 which = 2;
6757 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006758
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006759 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006760 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006761 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
6762 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006763 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006764 return;
6765 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006766
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006767 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006768 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006769 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006770 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006771 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
6772 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6773 else {
6774 int index = 0;
6775 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
6776 index = TTP->getIndex();
6777 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
6778 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
6779 index = NTTP->getIndex();
6780 else
6781 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006782 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006783 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
6784 << (index + 1);
6785 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006786 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006787 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006788
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006789 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
6790 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
6791 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
6792 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006793
6794 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
6795 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006796 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006797 return;
6798
6799 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
6800 std::string ArgString;
6801 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
6802 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
6803 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6804 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
6805 *Args);
6806 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
6807 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006808 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006809 return;
6810 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006811
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006812 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
6813 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006814 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006815 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
6816 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006817 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006818 return;
6819 }
6820}
6821
6822/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
6823/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
6824///
6825/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
6826/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
6827/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
6828/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
6829/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
6830/// overload.
6831///
6832/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
6833/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
6834/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006835void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6836 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006837 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6838
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006839 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006840 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->isUnavailable())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006841 std::string FnDesc;
6842 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006843
6844 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006845 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006846 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006847 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006848 }
6849
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006850 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
6851 if (Cand->Viable) {
6852 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
6853 return;
6854 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006855
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006856 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
6857 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
6858 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
6859 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006860
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006861 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006862 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
6863
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006864 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
6865 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006866 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006867 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006868
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006869 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
6870 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
6871 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006872 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
6873 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006874
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006875 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
6876 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
6877 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
6878 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006879 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006880 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006881}
6882
6883void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6884 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
6885 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
6886 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
6887 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
6888 bool isLValueReference = false;
6889 bool isRValueReference = false;
6890 bool isPointer = false;
6891 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6892 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
6893 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6894 isLValueReference = true;
6895 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6896 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
6897 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6898 isRValueReference = true;
6899 }
6900 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6901 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6902 isPointer = true;
6903 }
6904 // Desugar down to a function type.
6905 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
6906 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
6907 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
6908 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
6909 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
6910
6911 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
6912 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006913 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006914}
6915
6916void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
6917 const char *Opc,
6918 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6919 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6920 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
6921 std::string TypeStr("operator");
6922 TypeStr += Opc;
6923 TypeStr += "(";
6924 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
6925 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
6926 TypeStr += ")";
6927 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6928 } else {
6929 TypeStr += ", ";
6930 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
6931 TypeStr += ")";
6932 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6933 }
6934}
6935
6936void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6937 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6938 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
6939 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
6940 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006941 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
6942 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
6943
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006944 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006945 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006946 }
6947}
6948
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006949SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6950 if (Cand->Function)
6951 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006952 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006953 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
6954 return SourceLocation();
6955}
6956
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006957struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
6958 Sema &S;
6959 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006960
6961 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
6962 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006963 // Fast-path this check.
6964 if (L == R) return false;
6965
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006966 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006967 if (L->Viable) {
6968 if (!R->Viable) return true;
6969
6970 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
6971 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
6972 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006973 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
6974 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006975 } else if (R->Viable)
6976 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006977
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006978 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006979
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006980 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
6981 if (!L->Viable) {
6982 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
6983 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6984 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6985 return false;
6986 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6987 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6988 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006989
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006990 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
6991 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
6992 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
6993 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6994 return true;
6995
6996 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
6997 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
6998 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
6999
7000 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00007001 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
7002 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007003 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7004 L->Conversions[I],
7005 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007006 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7007 leftBetter++;
7008 break;
7009
7010 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7011 leftBetter--;
7012 break;
7013
7014 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7015 break;
7016 }
7017 }
7018 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
7019 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
7020
7021 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7022 return false;
7023
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007024 // TODO: others?
7025 }
7026
7027 // Sort everything else by location.
7028 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
7029 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
7030
7031 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
7032 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
7033 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
7034
7035 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007036 }
7037};
7038
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007039/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
7040/// computes up to the first
7041void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7042 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7043 assert(!Cand->Viable);
7044
7045 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
7046 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
7047
7048 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007049 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007050 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
7051 while (true) {
7052 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7053 ConvIdx++;
7054 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
7055 break;
7056 }
7057
7058 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7059 return;
7060
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007061 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7062 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7063
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00007064 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007065 // operation somehow.
7066 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007067
7068 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7069 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7070
7071 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7072 QualType ConvType
7073 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7074 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7075 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7076 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7077 ArgIdx--;
7078 } else if (Cand->Function) {
7079 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7080 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7081 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7082 ArgIdx--;
7083 } else {
7084 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7085 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7086 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7087 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007088 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7089 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007090 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007091 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007092 return;
7093 }
7094
7095 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7096 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7097 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
7098 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
7099 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007100 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007101 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007102 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007103 else
7104 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7105 }
7106}
7107
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007108} // end anonymous namespace
7109
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007110/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7111/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007112/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007113void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7114 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7115 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7116 const char *Opc,
7117 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007118 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
7119 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
7120 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007121 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7122 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007123 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007124 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007125 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007126 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007127 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7128 Cands.push_back(Cand);
7129 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
7130 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007131 }
7132 }
7133
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007134 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007135 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007136
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007137 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007138
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007139 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007140 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007141 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007142 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7143 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00007144
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007145 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7146 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7147 // candidate list.
7148 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
7149 break;
7150 }
7151 ++CandsShown;
7152
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007153 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007154 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007155 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007156 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007157 else {
7158 assert(Cand->Viable &&
7159 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007160 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7161 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7162 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7163 //
7164 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7165 // different ambiguities, though.
7166 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007167 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007168 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7169 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007170
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007171 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007172 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007173 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007174 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007175
7176 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007177 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007178}
7179
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007180// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
7181// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7182// R (A) --> R(A)
7183// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7184// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7185// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7186QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7187 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7188 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7189 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7190 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7191 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7192 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7193 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007194 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007195 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7196 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7197 Ret =
7198 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7199 return Ret;
7200}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007201
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007202// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7203// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7204class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7205{
7206 Sema& S;
7207 Expr* SourceExpr;
7208 const QualType& TargetType;
7209 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7210
7211 bool Complain;
7212 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7213 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007214
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007215 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7216 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007217
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007218 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7219 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7220 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007221 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007222
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007223public:
7224 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7225 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7226 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7227 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7228 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7229 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7230 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7231 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7232 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7233 {
7234 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7235
7236 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7237 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7238 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007239 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007240 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00007241
7242 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7243 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7244 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7245 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7246 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7247 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7248
7249 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7250 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7251 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7252 return;
7253 }
7254 }
7255
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007256 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7257 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007258 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007259 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007260 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007261
7262 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7263 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007264
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007265 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7266 // C++ [over.over]p4:
7267 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
7268 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7269 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7270 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7271 else
7272 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7273 }
7274 }
7275 }
7276
7277private:
7278 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7279 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7280 }
7281
7282 // [ToType] [Return]
7283
7284 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7285 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7286 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7287 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7288 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7289 }
7290
7291 // return true if any matching specializations were found
7292 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7293 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7294 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7295 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7296 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7297 // static when converting to member pointer.
7298 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7299 return false;
7300 }
7301 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7302 return false;
7303
7304 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7305 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7306 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7307 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7308 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7309 // overloaded functions considered.
7310 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7311 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7312 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7313 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7314 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7315 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7316 Info)) {
7317 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7318 (void)Result;
7319 return false;
7320 }
7321
7322 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
7323 // This function template specicalization works.
7324 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
7325 assert(TargetFunctionType
7326 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
7327 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
7328 return true;
7329 }
7330
7331 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
7332 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007333 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007334 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
7335 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007336 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7337 return false;
7338 }
7339 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7340 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007341
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007342 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007343 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007344 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
7345 FunDecl->getType()) ||
7346 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007347 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007348 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
7349 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007350 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007351 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007352 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007353 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007354
7355 return false;
7356 }
7357
7358 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
7359 bool Ret = false;
7360
7361 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
7362 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
7363 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7364 return false;
7365
7366 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7367 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7368 I != E; ++I) {
7369 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
7370 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
7371
7372 // C++ [over.over]p3:
7373 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
7374 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
7375 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
7376 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
7377 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
7378 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7379 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
7380 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
7381 Ret = true;
7382 }
7383 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
7384 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
7385 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
7386 Ret = true;
7387 }
7388 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
7389 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007390 }
7391
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007392 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007393 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
7394 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
7395 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
7396 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
7397 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
7398
7399 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
7400 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
7401 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
7402 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007403
7404 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
7405 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
7406 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007407
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007408 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007409 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
7410 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
7411 S.PDiag(),
7412 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7413 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
7414 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7415 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
7416 Complain);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007417
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007418 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
7419 // Make it the first and only element
7420 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
7421 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
7422 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007423 }
7424 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007425
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007426 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
7427 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
7428 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
7429 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
7430 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
7431 ++I;
7432 else {
7433 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
7434 Matches.set_size(N);
7435 }
7436 }
7437 }
7438
7439public:
7440 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
7441 assert(Matches.empty());
7442 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
7443 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
7444 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7445 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7446 }
7447
7448 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7449 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
7450 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
7451 }
7452
7453 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7454 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
7455 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
7456 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
7457 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
7458 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7459 }
7460
7461 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
7462 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
7463 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
7464 }
7465
7466 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
7467 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
7468 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7469 << OvlExpr->getName()
7470 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7471 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7472 }
7473
7474 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
7475
7476 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
7477 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7478 return Matches[0].second;
7479 }
7480
7481 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
7482 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7483 return &Matches[0].first;
7484 }
7485};
7486
7487/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
7488/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
7489/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
7490/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
7491///
7492/// @code
7493/// int f(double);
7494/// int f(int);
7495///
7496/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
7497/// @endcode
7498///
7499/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
7500/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
7501/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
7502FunctionDecl *
7503Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
7504 bool Complain,
7505 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
7506
7507 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7508
7509 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
7510 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
7511 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
7512 if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
7513 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7514 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
7515 else
7516 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
7517 }
7518 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
7519 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
7520 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
7521 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
7522 assert(Fn);
7523 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
7524 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007525 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007526 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00007527 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007528
7529 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007530}
7531
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007532/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007533/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
7534///
7535/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
7536/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007537/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007538/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007539FunctionDecl *
7540Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
7541 bool Complain,
7542 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007543 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7544 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
7545 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007546 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7547 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
7548 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007549
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007550 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007551 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007552 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007553
7554 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007555 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007556
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007557 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
7558 // whose type matches exactly.
7559 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007560 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
7561 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007562 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
7563 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007564 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
7565 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
7566 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007567 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007568 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7569 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007570
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007571 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7572 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7573 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7574 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7575 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7576 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007577 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007578 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007579 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7580 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7581 Specialization, Info)) {
7582 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7583 (void)Result;
7584 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007585 }
7586
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007587 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
7588
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007589 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007590 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007591 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007592 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7593 << ovl->getName();
7594 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007595 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007596 return 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007597 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007598
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007599 Matched = Specialization;
7600 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007601 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007602
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007603 return Matched;
7604}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007605
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007606
7607
7608
7609// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that
7610// can be resolved because it identifies a single function
7611// template specialization
7612// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
7613ExprResult Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007614 Expr *SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, bool complain,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007615 const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
7616 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007617 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
7618 assert(SrcExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007619
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007620 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007621
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007622 DeclAccessPair found;
7623 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
7624 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7625 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
7626 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin()))
7627 return ExprError();
7628
7629 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
7630 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
7631 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
7632 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
7633 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
7634 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
7635 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
7636 if (complain) {
7637 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
7638 diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
7639 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
7640 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
7641 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
7642 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
7643 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
7644 // the static candidates were rejected.
7645 }
7646
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007647 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007648 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007649
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007650 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
7651 SingleFunctionExpression =
7652 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr, found, fn));
7653
7654 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
7655 if (doFunctionPointerConverion)
7656 SingleFunctionExpression =
7657 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
7658 }
7659
7660 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
7661 if (complain) {
7662 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
7663 << ovl.Expression->getName()
7664 << DestTypeForComplaining
7665 << OpRangeForComplaining
7666 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
7667 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr);
7668 }
7669 return ExprError();
7670 }
7671
7672 return SingleFunctionExpression;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007673}
7674
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007675/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
7676static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007677 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007678 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007679 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7680 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7681 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007682 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007683 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
7684 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
7685
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007686 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007687 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007688 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007689 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007690 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007691 }
7692
7693 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
7694 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007695 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
7696 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007697 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007698 return;
7699 }
7700
7701 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
7702
7703 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007704}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007705
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007706/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
7707/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007708void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007709 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7710 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7711 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007712
7713#ifndef NDEBUG
7714 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
7715 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007716 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007717 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
7718 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
7719 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
7720 //
7721 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
7722 //
7723 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007724 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007725 //
7726 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
7727 // template
7728 //
7729 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007730
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007731 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7732 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7733 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7734 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
7735 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
7736 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
7737 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007738 }
7739 }
7740#endif
7741
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007742 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
7743 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007744 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007745 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7746 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7747 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7748 }
7749
7750 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7751 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007752 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007753 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007754 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007755
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007756 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007757 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
7758 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007759 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007760 CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007761 PartialOverloading,
7762 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007763}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007764
7765/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
7766///
7767/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007768static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007769BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007770 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
7771 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7772 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007773 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007774
7775 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007776 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007777
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007778 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7779 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7780 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7781 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7782 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7783 }
7784
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007785 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
7786 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00007787 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007788 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007789
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007790 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
7791
7792 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
7793 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007794 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007795 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007796 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
7797 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007798 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7799 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
7800 else
7801 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
7802
7803 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007804 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007805
7806 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
7807 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
7808 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007809 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007810 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007811}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00007812
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007813/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007814/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
7815/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
7816/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
7817/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00007818/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007819/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007820ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007821Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007822 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7823 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007824 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7825 Expr *ExecConfig) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007826#ifndef NDEBUG
7827 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7828 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
7829 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
7830
7831 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
7832 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
7833 FunctionDecl *F;
7834 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
7835 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
7836 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
7837 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007838
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007839 // We don't perform ADL in C.
7840 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007841 } else
7842 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
7843 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007844#endif
7845
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007846 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00007847
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007848 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
7849 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
7850 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007851
7852 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
7853 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
7854 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007855 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007856 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007857 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007858
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007859 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007860 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007861 case OR_Success: {
7862 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007863 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007864 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007865 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
7866 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007867 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007868 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
7869 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007870 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007871
7872 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00007873 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007874 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007875 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007876 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007877 break;
7878
7879 case OR_Ambiguous:
7880 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007881 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007882 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007883 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007884
7885 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007886 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007887 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
7888 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7889 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00007890 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007891 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007892 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
7893 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007894 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007895 }
7896
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007897 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007898 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007899}
7900
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007901static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00007902 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
7903 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
7904}
7905
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007906/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7907/// operator.
7908///
7909/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
7910///
7911/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7912/// operator.
7913///
7914/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7915/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7916/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7917/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7918/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7919/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
7920///
7921/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007922ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007923Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
7924 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007925 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007926 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007927
7928 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7929 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
7930 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007931 // TODO: provide better source location info.
7932 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007933
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007934 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7935 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
7936 if (Result.isInvalid())
7937 return ExprError();
7938 Input = Result.take();
7939 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007940
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007941 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
7942 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007943
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007944 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
7945 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
7946 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007947 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007948 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00007949 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
7950 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007951 NumArgs = 2;
7952 }
7953
7954 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007955 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007956 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007957 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007958 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007959 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007960 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007961
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007962 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007963 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007964 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007965 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007966 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7967 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007968 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007969 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007970 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007971 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007972 OpLoc));
7973 }
7974
7975 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007976 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007977
7978 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007979 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007980
7981 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7982 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
7983
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007984 // Add candidates from ADL.
7985 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00007986 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007987 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7988 CandidateSet);
7989
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007990 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007991 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007992
7993 // Perform overload resolution.
7994 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007995 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007996 case OR_Success: {
7997 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7998 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007999
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008000 if (FnDecl) {
8001 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8002 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008003
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008004 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8005
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008006 // Convert the arguments.
8007 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008008 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008009
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008010 ExprResult InputRes =
8011 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8012 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8013 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008014 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008015 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008016 } else {
8017 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008018 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008019 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008020 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00008021 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008022 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008023 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008024 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008025 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008026 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008027 }
8028
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008029 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8030
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008031 // Determine the result type.
8032 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8033 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8034 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008035
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008036 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008037 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
8038 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8039 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008040
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00008041 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008042 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008043 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008044 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008045
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008046 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00008047 FnDecl))
8048 return ExprError();
8049
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008050 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008051 } else {
8052 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8053 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8054 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008055 ExprResult InputRes =
8056 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8057 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8058 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
8059 return ExprError();
8060 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008061 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008062 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008063 }
8064
8065 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8066 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
8067 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
8068 break;
8069
8070 case OR_Ambiguous:
8071 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8072 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8073 << Input->getType()
8074 << Input->getSourceRange();
8075 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
8076 Args, NumArgs,
8077 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8078 return ExprError();
8079
8080 case OR_Deleted:
8081 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8082 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8083 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8084 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8085 << Input->getSourceRange();
8086 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8087 return ExprError();
8088 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008089
8090 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8091 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8092 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008093 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008094}
8095
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008096/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8097/// operator.
8098///
8099/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8100///
8101/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8102/// operator.
8103///
8104/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8105/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8106/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8107/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8108/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8109/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8110///
8111/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8112/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008113ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008114Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008115 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008116 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008117 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008118 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008119 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008120
8121 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8122 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8123 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8124
8125 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8126 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008127 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008128 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008129 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008130 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008131 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008132 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008133 Context.DependentTy,
8134 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8135 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008136
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008137 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8138 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008139 VK_LValue,
8140 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008141 Context.DependentTy,
8142 Context.DependentTy,
8143 OpLoc));
8144 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008145
8146 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008147 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008148 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8149 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008150 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008151 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8152 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8153 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008154 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008155 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008156 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008157 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008158 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008159 OpLoc));
8160 }
8161
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008162 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008163 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8164 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8165 if (Result.isInvalid())
8166 return ExprError();
8167 Args[1] = Result.take();
8168 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008169
8170 // The LHS is more complicated.
8171 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8172
8173 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
8174 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
8175 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
8176 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
8177
8178 // Is the property "logically" settable?
8179 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
8180 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
8181
8182 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
8183 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
8184 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
8185 // load and hope.
8186 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
8187 // we really should use the primitive.
8188 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
8189 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
8190 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
8191 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
8192 if (Settable)
8193 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8194 }
8195
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008196 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8197 if (Result.isInvalid())
8198 return ExprError();
8199 Args[0] = Result.take();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008200 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008201
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00008202 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
8203 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
8204 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
8205 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
8206 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
8207 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008208 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008209 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008210
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008211 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
8212 // create a built-in binary operator.
8213 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
8214 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8215
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008216 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008217 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008218
8219 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008220 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008221
8222 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8223 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8224
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008225 // Add candidates from ADL.
8226 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8227 Args, 2,
8228 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8229 CandidateSet);
8230
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008231 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008232 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008233
8234 // Perform overload resolution.
8235 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008236 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008237 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008238 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8239 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8240
8241 if (FnDecl) {
8242 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8243 // operator.
8244
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008245 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8246
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008247 // Convert the arguments.
8248 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008249 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008250 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008251
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008252 ExprResult Arg1 =
8253 PerformCopyInitialization(
8254 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8255 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8256 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008257 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008258 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008259
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008260 ExprResult Arg0 =
8261 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8262 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8263 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008264 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008265 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008266 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008267 } else {
8268 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008269 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
8270 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8271 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8272 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008273 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008274 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008275
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008276 ExprResult Arg1 =
8277 PerformCopyInitialization(
8278 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8279 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
8280 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008281 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
8282 return ExprError();
8283 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
8284 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008285 }
8286
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008287 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8288
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008289 // Determine the result type.
8290 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8291 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8292 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008293
8294 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008295 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
8296 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8297 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008298
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008299 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008300 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008301 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008302
8303 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008304 FnDecl))
8305 return ExprError();
8306
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008307 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008308 } else {
8309 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8310 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8311 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008312 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8313 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8314 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8315 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008316 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008317 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008318
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008319 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8320 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8321 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8322 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8323 return ExprError();
8324 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008325 break;
8326 }
8327 }
8328
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008329 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8330 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
8331 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
8332 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
8333 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008334 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008335 break;
8336
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008337 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
8338 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
8339 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008340 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008341 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008342 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008343 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
8344 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008345 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008346 } else {
8347 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
8348 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
8349 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008350 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008351 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008352 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
8353 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008354 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8355 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008356 return move(Result);
8357 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008358
8359 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008360 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008361 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008362 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008363 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008364 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8365 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008366 return ExprError();
8367
8368 case OR_Deleted:
8369 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8370 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8371 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008372 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008373 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008374 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008375 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008376 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008377
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008378 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008379 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008380}
8381
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008382ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008383Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
8384 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008385 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
8386 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008387 DeclarationName OpName =
8388 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
8389
8390 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8391 // expression.
8392 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8393
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008394 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008395 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
8396 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
8397 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008398 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008399 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008400 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008401 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
8402 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
8403 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008404 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008405
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008406 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
8407 Args, 2,
8408 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008409 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008410 RLoc));
8411 }
8412
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008413 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8414 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8415 if (Result.isInvalid())
8416 return ExprError();
8417 Args[0] = Result.take();
8418 }
8419 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8420 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8421 if (Result.isInvalid())
8422 return ExprError();
8423 Args[1] = Result.take();
8424 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008425
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008426 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008427 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008428
8429 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
8430
8431 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8432 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8433
8434 // Add builtin operator candidates.
8435 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8436
8437 // Perform overload resolution.
8438 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008439 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008440 case OR_Success: {
8441 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8442 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8443
8444 if (FnDecl) {
8445 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8446 // operator.
8447
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008448 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
8449
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008450 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008451 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008452
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008453 // Convert the arguments.
8454 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008455 ExprResult Arg0 =
8456 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8457 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8458 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008459 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008460 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008461
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008462 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008463 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008464 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008465 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008466 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008467 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008468 Owned(Args[1]));
8469 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
8470 return ExprError();
8471
8472 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
8473
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008474 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008475 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8476 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8477 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008478
8479 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008480 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc);
8481 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8482 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008483
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008484 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8485 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008486 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008487 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008488
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008489 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008490 FnDecl))
8491 return ExprError();
8492
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008493 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008494 } else {
8495 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8496 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8497 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008498 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8499 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8500 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8501 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008502 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008503 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
8504
8505 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8506 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8507 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8508 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8509 return ExprError();
8510 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008511
8512 break;
8513 }
8514 }
8515
8516 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008517 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8518 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8519 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
8520 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
8521 else
8522 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
8523 << Args[0]->getType()
8524 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008525 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8526 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008527 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008528 }
8529
8530 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008531 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008532 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008533 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
8534 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008535 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8536 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008537 return ExprError();
8538
8539 case OR_Deleted:
8540 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8541 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008542 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008543 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008544 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8545 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008546 return ExprError();
8547 }
8548
8549 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008550 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008551}
8552
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008553/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
8554/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
8555/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
8556/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
8557/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008558/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
8559/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008560ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008561Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
8562 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008563 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008564 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
8565 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8566
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008567 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
8568 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008569 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008570
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008571 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
8572 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
8573 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
8574 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
8575
8576 QualType fnType =
8577 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8578
8579 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8580 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
8581 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
8582
8583 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
8584 // member function we're calling.
8585 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
8586
8587 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
8588 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
8589 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8590 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
8591
8592 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
8593 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
8594 difference.removeAddressSpace();
8595 if (difference) {
8596 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
8597 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
8598 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
8599 << qualsString
8600 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
8601 }
8602
8603 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
8604 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
8605 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
8606
8607 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
8608 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8609 call, 0))
8610 return ExprError();
8611
8612 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
8613 return ExprError();
8614
8615 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
8616 }
8617
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008618 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008619 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00008620 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008621 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008622 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
8623 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008624 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008625 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008626 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008627 } else {
8628 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008629 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008630
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008631 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008632 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
8633 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
8634 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008635
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008636 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008637 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008638
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008639 // FIXME: avoid copy.
8640 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
8641 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8642 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8643 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
8644 }
8645
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008646 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
8647 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8648
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008649 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
8650 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
8651 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
8652 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
8653
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008654
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +00008655 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
8656 if (getLangOptions().Microsoft && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
8657 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
8658 CandidateSet);
8659 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008660 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
8661 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008662 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008663 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008664
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008665 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008666 ObjectClassification,
8667 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008668 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008669 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008670 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008671 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008672 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008673 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008674 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008675 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008676 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008677
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008678 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
8679
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008680 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008681 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008682 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008683 case OR_Success:
8684 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008685 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008686 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008687 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008688 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008689 break;
8690
8691 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008692 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008693 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008694 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008695 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008696 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008697 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008698
8699 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008700 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008701 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008702 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008703 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008704 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008705
8706 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008707 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008708 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008709 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008710 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008711 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008712 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008713 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008714 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008715 }
8716
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008717 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008719 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
8720 // non-member call based on that function.
8721 if (Method->isStatic()) {
8722 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
8723 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
8724 }
8725
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008726 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008727 }
8728
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008729 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
8730 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
8731 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8732
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008733 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008734 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008735 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008736 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008737
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00008738 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008739 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008740 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008741 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008742
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008743 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008744 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
8745 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008746 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8747 ExprResult ObjectArg =
8748 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
8749 FoundDecl, Method);
8750 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
8751 return ExprError();
8752 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
8753 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008754
8755 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008756 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8757 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008758 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008759 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008760 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008761
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008762 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008763 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00008764
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008765 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008766}
8767
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008768/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
8769/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
8770/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
8771/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008772ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008773Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00008774 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008775 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008776 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008777 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
8778 if (Object.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8779 Object = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object.take());
8780 if (Object.isInvalid())
8781 return ExprError();
8782 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008783
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008784 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
8785 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008786
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008787 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
8788 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00008789 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008790 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
8791 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
8792 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
8793 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008794 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00008795 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008796
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008797 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008798 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008799 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008800 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008801
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008802 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8803 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
8804 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8805
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008806 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008807 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008808 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
8809 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00008810 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008811 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008812
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008813 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
8814 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
8815 // form
8816 //
8817 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
8818 //
8819 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
8820 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00008821 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
8822 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
8823 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
8824 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008825 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
8826 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
8827 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
8828 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
8829 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008830 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00008831 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008832 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008833 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008834 NamedDecl *D = *I;
8835 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
8836 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8837 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008838
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008839 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
8840 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008841 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008842 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008843
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008844 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008845
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008846 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
8847 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
8848 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8849 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8850 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008851
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008852 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008853 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008854 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008855 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008856
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008857 // Perform overload resolution.
8858 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008859 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008860 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008861 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008862 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
8863 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008864 break;
8865
8866 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008867 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008868 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8869 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
8870 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008871 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008872 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008873 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008874 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008875 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008876 break;
8877
8878 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008879 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008880 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008881 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008882 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008883 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008884
8885 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008886 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008887 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
8888 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008889 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008890 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008891 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008892 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008893 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008894 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008895
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008896 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008897 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008898
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008899 if (Best->Function == 0) {
8900 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
8901 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008902 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008903 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
8904 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
8905
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008906 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008907 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008908
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008909 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
8910 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
8911 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008912
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00008913 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008914 // and then call it.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008915 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, Conv);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008916 if (Call.isInvalid())
8917 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008918
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008919 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008920 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008921 }
8922
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008923 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008924 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008925 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008926
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008927 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
8928 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
8929 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
8930 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008931 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8932 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008933
8934 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8935 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
8936
8937 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
8938 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
8939 // list).
8940 Expr **MethodArgs;
8941 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
8942 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8943 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
8944 } else {
8945 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
8946 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008947 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008948 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
8949 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008950
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008951 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
8952 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
8953 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008954
8955 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
8956 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008957 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8958 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8959 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8960
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008961 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008962 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008963 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008964 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008965 delete [] MethodArgs;
8966
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008967 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00008968 Method))
8969 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008970
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008971 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
8972 // slots in the call for them.
8973 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00008974 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008975 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
8976 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8977
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008978 bool IsError = false;
8979
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008980 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008981 ExprResult ObjRes =
8982 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
8983 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8984 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
8985 IsError = true;
8986 else
8987 Object = move(ObjRes);
8988 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008989
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008990 // Check the argument types.
8991 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008992 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008993 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008994 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008995
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008996 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008997
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008998 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008999 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009000 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009001 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009002 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009003
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009004 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
9005 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009006 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009007 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009008 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
9009 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
9010 IsError = true;
9011 break;
9012 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009013
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009014 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009015 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009016
9017 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
9018 }
9019
9020 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
9021 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
9022 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
9023 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009024 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
9025 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
9026 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009027 }
9028 }
9029
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009030 if (IsError) return true;
9031
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009032 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00009033 return true;
9034
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00009035 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009036}
9037
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009038/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009039/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009040/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009041ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009042Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009043 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
9044 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009045
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009046 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9047 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
9048 if (Result.isInvalid())
9049 return ExprError();
9050 Base = Result.take();
9051 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009052
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009053 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
9054
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009055 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
9056 //
9057 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
9058 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
9059 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
9060 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009061 DeclarationName OpName =
9062 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009063 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00009064 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009065
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009066 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00009067 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
9068 << Base->getSourceRange()))
9069 return ExprError();
9070
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00009071 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9072 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
9073 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00009074
9075 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009076 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009077 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
9078 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009079 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009080
9081 // Perform overload resolution.
9082 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009083 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009084 case OR_Success:
9085 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
9086 break;
9087
9088 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9089 if (CandidateSet.empty())
9090 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009091 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009092 else
9093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009094 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009095 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009096 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009097
9098 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009099 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9100 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009101 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009102 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009103
9104 case OR_Deleted:
9105 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9106 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009107 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009108 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009109 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009110 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009111 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009112 }
9113
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009114 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009115 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009116 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009117
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009118 // Convert the object parameter.
9119 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009120 ExprResult BaseResult =
9121 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9122 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9123 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009124 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009125 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00009126
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009127 // Build the operator call.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009128 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9129 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9130 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009131
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009132 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9133 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9134 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009135 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009136 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009137 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009138
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009139 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009140 Method))
9141 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +00009142
9143 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009144}
9145
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009146/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
9147/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
9148/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
9149/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00009150/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00009151Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009152 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009153 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009154 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
9155 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009156 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009157 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009158
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009159 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009160 }
9161
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009162 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009163 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
9164 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009165 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009166 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00009167 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009168 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009169 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009170 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009171
9172 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009173 ICE->getCastKind(),
9174 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00009175 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009176 }
9177
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009178 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009179 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009180 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009181 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9182 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9183 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
9184 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009185 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009186 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
9187 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
9188 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009189 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9190 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009191 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009192 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009193
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009194 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
9195 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
9196 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
9197 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
9198
9199 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
9200 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
9201 // appropriate pointer to member type.
9202 QualType ClassType
9203 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
9204 QualType MemPtrType
9205 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
9206
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009207 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
9208 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9209 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009210 }
9211 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009212 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9213 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009214 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009215 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009216
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009217 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009218 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009219 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009220 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009221 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009222
9223 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009224 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9225 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009226 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009227 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9228 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009229 }
9230
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009231 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009232 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009233 Fn,
9234 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009235 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009236 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009237 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009238 }
9239
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009240 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009241 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009242 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9243 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9244 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9245 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9246 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009247
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009248 Expr *Base;
9249
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009250 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
9251 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009252 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
9253 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9254 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009255 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009256 Fn,
9257 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9258 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009259 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009260 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009261 } else {
9262 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
9263 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009264 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009265 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
9266 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
9267 /*isImplicit=*/true);
9268 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009269 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009270 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009271
9272 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009273 MemExpr->isArrow(),
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009274 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009275 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009276 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009277 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009278 TemplateArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009279 Fn->getType(),
9280 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()
9281 ? VK_LValue : VK_RValue,
9282 OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009283 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009284
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009285 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
9286 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009287}
9288
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009289ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009290 DeclAccessPair Found,
9291 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009292 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00009293}
9294
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009295} // end namespace clang